]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blame - ld/ld.texi
Handle -z unique/-z nounique in ld
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
CommitLineData
252b5132
RH
1\input texinfo
2@setfilename ld.info
b3adc24a 3@c Copyright (C) 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 4@syncodeindex ky cp
dff70155 5@c man begin INCLUDE
252b5132
RH
6@include configdoc.texi
7@c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
c428fa83 8@include bfdver.texi
dff70155 9@c man end
252b5132
RH
10
11@c @smallbook
12
ff5dcc92
SC
13@macro gcctabopt{body}
14@code{\body\}
15@end macro
16
0285c67d
NC
17@c man begin NAME
18@ifset man
19@c Configure for the generation of man pages
20@set UsesEnvVars
21@set GENERIC
0285c67d 22@set ARM
ac145307 23@set C6X
b8891f8d 24@set CSKY
49fa1e15 25@set H8300
0285c67d 26@set HPPA
0285c67d 27@set M68HC11
7fb9f789 28@set M68K
833794fc 29@set MIPS
3c3bdf30 30@set MMIX
2469cfa2 31@set MSP430
35c08157 32@set NDS32
78058a5e 33@set NIOSII
fa1477dc 34@set PDP11
2a60a7a8
AM
35@set POWERPC
36@set POWERPC64
49fa1e15 37@set Renesas
b4cbbe8f 38@set S/390
49fa1e15
AM
39@set SPU
40@set TICOFF
2ca22b03 41@set WIN32
e0001a05 42@set XTENSA
0285c67d
NC
43@end ifset
44@c man end
45
9160ea82
AM
46@ifnottex
47@dircategory Software development
48@direntry
252b5132 49* Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
9160ea82
AM
50@end direntry
51@end ifnottex
252b5132 52
0e9517a9 53@copying
e49e529d
JM
54This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57@end ifset
58version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 59
b3adc24a 60Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 61
cf055d54 62Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 63under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
cf055d54
NC
64or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 67section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0e9517a9 68@end copying
252b5132
RH
69@iftex
70@finalout
71@setchapternewpage odd
71ba23f6 72@settitle The GNU linker
252b5132 73@titlepage
71ba23f6 74@title The GNU linker
252b5132 75@sp 1
e49e529d
JM
76@subtitle @code{ld}
77@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79@end ifset
252b5132
RH
80@subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81@author Steve Chamberlain
82@author Ian Lance Taylor
252b5132
RH
83@page
84
85@tex
86{\parskip=0pt
704c465c
NC
87\hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88\hfill nickc\@credhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
71ba23f6 89\hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
252b5132
RH
90\hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91}
92\global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93@end tex
94
95@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
0285c67d 96@c man begin COPYRIGHT
b3adc24a 97Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 98
0285c67d 99Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 100under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
0285c67d
NC
101or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 104section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0285c67d 105@c man end
252b5132 106
252b5132
RH
107@end titlepage
108@end iftex
4ecceb71 109@contents
252b5132
RH
110@c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
84ec0e6d 112@ifnottex
252b5132 113@node Top
71ba23f6 114@top LD
e49e529d
JM
115This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118@end ifset
119version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 120
cf055d54 121This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
793c5807
NC
122Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
cf055d54 124
252b5132
RH
125@menu
126* Overview:: Overview
127* Invocation:: Invocation
128* Scripts:: Linker Scripts
bf6d8037 129* Plugins:: Linker Plugins
252b5132
RH
130@ifset GENERIC
131* Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
132@end ifset
133@ifclear GENERIC
134@ifset H8300
135* H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
136@end ifset
c2dcd04e
NC
137@ifset Renesas
138* Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
252b5132 139@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
140@ifset ARM
141* ARM:: ld and the ARM family
142@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
143@ifset M68HC11
144* M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
145@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
146@ifset HPPA
147* HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
148@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
149@ifset M68K
150* M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
151@end ifset
833794fc
MR
152@ifset MIPS
153* MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
154@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
155@ifset POWERPC
156* PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
157@end ifset
158@ifset POWERPC64
159* PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
160@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
161@ifset S/390
162* S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
163@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
164@ifset SPU
165* SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
166@end ifset
74459f0e
TW
167@ifset TICOFF
168* TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
169@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
170@ifset WIN32
171* Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
172@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
173@ifset XTENSA
174* Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
175@end ifset
252b5132
RH
176@end ifclear
177@ifclear SingleFormat
178* BFD:: BFD
179@end ifclear
180@c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
181
182* Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
183* MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
704c465c 184* GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
370b66a1 185* LD Index:: LD Index
252b5132 186@end menu
84ec0e6d 187@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
188
189@node Overview
190@chapter Overview
191
192@cindex @sc{gnu} linker
193@cindex what is this?
0285c67d 194
0879a67a 195@ifset man
0285c67d 196@c man begin SYNOPSIS
ff5dcc92 197ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
0285c67d
NC
198@c man end
199
200@c man begin SEEALSO
201ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
202the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
203@file{ld}.
204@c man end
205@end ifset
206
207@c man begin DESCRIPTION
208
ff5dcc92 209@command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
252b5132 210their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
ff5dcc92 211compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
252b5132 212
ff5dcc92 213@command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
252b5132
RH
214a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
215to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
216
0285c67d
NC
217@ifset man
218@c For the man only
ece2d90e 219This man page does not describe the command language; see the
71ba23f6
NC
220@command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
221language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
0285c67d
NC
222@end ifset
223
252b5132 224@ifclear SingleFormat
ff5dcc92
SC
225This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
226to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
252b5132
RH
227write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
228@code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
229available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
230@end ifclear
231
232Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
233linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
234execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
ff5dcc92 235@command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
252b5132
RH
236(or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
237
0285c67d
NC
238@c man end
239
252b5132
RH
240@node Invocation
241@chapter Invocation
242
0285c67d
NC
243@c man begin DESCRIPTION
244
ff5dcc92 245The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
252b5132
RH
246and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
247you have many choices to control its behavior.
248
0285c67d
NC
249@c man end
250
252b5132
RH
251@ifset UsesEnvVars
252@menu
a05a5b64 253* Options:: Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
254* Environment:: Environment Variables
255@end menu
256
257@node Options
a05a5b64 258@section Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
259@end ifset
260
261@cindex command line
262@cindex options
0285c67d
NC
263
264@c man begin OPTIONS
265
252b5132
RH
266The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
267practice few of them are used in any particular context.
268@cindex standard Unix system
ff5dcc92 269For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
252b5132
RH
270object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
271link a file @code{hello.o}:
272
273@smallexample
274ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
275@end smallexample
276
ff5dcc92 277This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
252b5132
RH
278result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
279the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
280directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
281
ff5dcc92 282Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
511ab9e9
ILT
283point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
284as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
285which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
286files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
287different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
252b5132
RH
288occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
289option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
290noted in the descriptions below.
291
292@cindex object files
511ab9e9
ILT
293Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
294together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
295options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
296an option and its argument.
252b5132
RH
297
298Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
299specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
300and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
301are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
302message @samp{No input files}.
303
36f63dca 304If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
252b5132
RH
305assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
306augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
307linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
308permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
309or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
53d25da6
AM
310@code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
311script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
312extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
313to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
314the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
252b5132
RH
315
316For options whose names are a single letter,
317option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
318whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
319option that requires them.
320
321For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
e4897a32 322precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
36f63dca 323@samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
e4897a32 324this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
ba1be17e 325only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
e4897a32
NC
326@samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
327name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
328output.
329
330Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
331option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
332immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
333@samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
334Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
335accepted.
252b5132 336
36f63dca 337Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
a05a5b64 338(e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
fa19fce0
NC
339prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
340compiler driver) like this:
4e53152f
NC
341
342@smallexample
2509a395 343 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
4e53152f
NC
344@end smallexample
345
346This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
2509a395
SL
347silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
348may also arise when passing options that require values through a
349driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
350a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
351and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
352the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
353
354@smallexample
355 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
356@end smallexample
4e53152f 357
a05a5b64 358Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
4e53152f
NC
359linker:
360
ff5dcc92 361@table @gcctabopt
38fc1cb1 362@include at-file.texi
dff70155 363
2509a395
SL
364@kindex -a @var{keyword}
365@item -a @var{keyword}
252b5132
RH
366This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
367argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
368@samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
369@samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
370to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
371
7ee314fa
AM
372@kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373@item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
374Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
375@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
376specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
377will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
378finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
9d5777a3 379it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
7ee314fa 380This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
9d5777a3 381interface.
7ee314fa 382
252b5132
RH
383@ifclear SingleFormat
384@cindex binary input format
385@kindex -b @var{format}
386@kindex --format=@var{format}
387@cindex input format
388@cindex input format
389@item -b @var{input-format}
390@itemx --format=@var{input-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
391@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
392file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 393@samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
ff5dcc92 394that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
252b5132 395configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
ff5dcc92 396to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
252b5132
RH
397default input format the most usual format on each machine.
398@var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
399supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
400formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
401@xref{BFD}.
402
403You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
404binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
405linking object files of different formats), by including
406@samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
a1ab1d2a 407particular format.
252b5132
RH
408
409The default format is taken from the environment variable
410@code{GNUTARGET}.
411@ifset UsesEnvVars
412@xref{Environment}.
413@end ifset
414You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
0285c67d
NC
415@code{TARGET};
416@ifclear man
417see @ref{Format Commands}.
418@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
419@end ifclear
420
421@kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
422@kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
423@cindex compatibility, MRI
424@item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
425@itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
ff5dcc92 426For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
252b5132 427files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
0285c67d
NC
428@ifclear man
429@ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
430@end ifclear
431@ifset man
432the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
433@end ifset
434Introduce MRI script files with
252b5132 435the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
ff5dcc92
SC
436scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
437If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
252b5132
RH
438specified by any @samp{-L} options.
439
440@cindex common allocation
441@kindex -d
442@kindex -dc
443@kindex -dp
a1ab1d2a 444@item -d
252b5132
RH
445@itemx -dc
446@itemx -dp
447These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
448compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
449even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
450script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
451@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
452
7ee314fa
AM
453@kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
454@kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
455@item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
456@itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
457Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
458@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
459specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
460will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
461option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
9d5777a3 462The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
7ee314fa 463
abf874aa
CL
464@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
465@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
466This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
467fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
468section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
469error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
470several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
471section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
472sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
473
474@smallexample
475 MEMORY @{
476 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
477 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
478 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
479 @}
480 SECTIONS @{
481 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
482 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
483 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
484 @}
485
486 with input sections:
487 .data.1: size 8
488 .data.2: size 0x10
489 .data.3: size 4
490
491 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
492 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
493@end smallexample
494
495This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
496the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
497
498@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
499@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
500This option enables warnings when
501@code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
502matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
503discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
504output region.
505
252b5132
RH
506@cindex entry point, from command line
507@kindex -e @var{entry}
508@kindex --entry=@var{entry}
a1ab1d2a 509@item -e @var{entry}
252b5132
RH
510@itemx --entry=@var{entry}
511Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
512program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
513named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
514and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
515base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
516@samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
517and other ways of specifying the entry point.
518
b58f81ae
DJ
519@kindex --exclude-libs
520@item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
521Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
e1c37eb5 522exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
b58f81ae
DJ
523@code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
524automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
525port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
526explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
527option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
528be treated as hidden.
529
e1c37eb5
DK
530@kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
531@item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
532Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
533should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
534into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
535may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
536used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
537the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
538match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
539command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
540of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
541regardless of this option.
542
252b5132
RH
543@cindex dynamic symbol table
544@kindex -E
545@kindex --export-dynamic
267e2722 546@kindex --no-export-dynamic
252b5132
RH
547@item -E
548@itemx --export-dynamic
267e2722
CD
549@itemx --no-export-dynamic
550When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
551option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
552all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
553set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
554
555If you do not use either of these options (or use the
556@option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
557dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
558referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
252b5132
RH
559
560If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
561back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
562dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
563linking the program itself.
564
55255dae 565You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
cb840a31 566be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
55255dae 567See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
cb840a31 568
8b747e1a
DK
569Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
570support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
571the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
572
37a141bf
FS
573@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
574@cindex export dynamic symbol
575@item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
576When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
577@var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
578shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
579bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
580no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
581@samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
582on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
583
584@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
585@cindex export dynamic symbol list
586@item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
587Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
588The format of the file is the same as the version node without
589scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
590
36f63dca 591@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
592@cindex big-endian objects
593@cindex endianness
594@kindex -EB
595@item -EB
596Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
597
598@cindex little-endian objects
599@kindex -EL
600@item -EL
601Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
36f63dca 602@end ifclear
252b5132 603
2509a395
SL
604@kindex -f @var{name}
605@kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
606@item -f @var{name}
607@itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
608When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
609to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
610table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
611symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
612
613If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
614run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
615the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
616first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
617@var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
618in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
619Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
620implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
a094d01f 621machine-specific performance.
252b5132
RH
622
623This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
624will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
625
2509a395
SL
626@kindex -F @var{name}
627@kindex --filter=@var{name}
252b5132 628@item -F @var{name}
2509a395 629@itemx --filter=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
630When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
631the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
632of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
633on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
634
635If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
636run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
637dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
638filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
639found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
640used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
641@var{name}.
642
ff5dcc92 643Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
252b5132 644toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
36f63dca
NC
645object files.
646@ifclear SingleFormat
647The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
ece2d90e 648@option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
252b5132 649@code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
36f63dca
NC
650environment variable.
651@end ifclear
652The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
653creating an ELF shared object.
252b5132 654
3dbf70a2 655@cindex finalization function
2509a395
SL
656@kindex -fini=@var{name}
657@item -fini=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
658When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
659executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
660address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
661the function to call.
662
252b5132
RH
663@kindex -g
664@item -g
665Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
666
2509a395
SL
667@kindex -G @var{value}
668@kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
252b5132 669@cindex object size
2509a395 670@item -G @var{value}
252b5132
RH
671@itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
672Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
673@var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
e8044f35 674MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
252b5132
RH
675sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
676
677@cindex runtime library name
2509a395 678@kindex -h @var{name}
252b5132 679@kindex -soname=@var{name}
2509a395 680@item -h @var{name}
252b5132
RH
681@itemx -soname=@var{name}
682When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
683the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
684which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
685linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
686field rather than the using the file name given to the linker.
687
688@kindex -i
689@cindex incremental link
690@item -i
691Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
692
3dbf70a2 693@cindex initialization function
2509a395
SL
694@kindex -init=@var{name}
695@item -init=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
696When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
697executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
698of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
699function to call.
700
252b5132 701@cindex archive files, from cmd line
2509a395 702@kindex -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf 703@kindex --library=@var{namespec}
2509a395 704@item -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf
RS
705@itemx --library=@var{namespec}
706Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
707list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
708If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
07d8eb55 709will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
bcb674cf 710will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
252b5132 711
ff5dcc92 712On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
bcb674cf
RS
713files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
714and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
715called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
716@file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
717indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
718to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
719@var{filename}.
252b5132
RH
720
721The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
722specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
723was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
724command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
725archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
726the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
727
ff5dcc92 728See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
252b5132
RH
729archives multiple times.
730
731You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
732
733@ifset GENERIC
734This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
ff5dcc92 735if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
252b5132
RH
736behaviour of the AIX linker.
737@end ifset
738
739@cindex search directory, from cmd line
2509a395 740@kindex -L @var{dir}
252b5132 741@kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
2509a395 742@item -L @var{searchdir}
252b5132 743@itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
ff5dcc92
SC
744Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
745for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
252b5132
RH
746option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
747in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
748on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
ff5dcc92 749@option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
7d24f02c
KH
750order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
751how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
752option is specified.
252b5132 753
3aa2d05a
NC
754If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
755prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
756@samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
9c8ebd6a 757
252b5132
RH
758@ifset UsesEnvVars
759The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
ff5dcc92 760@samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
252b5132
RH
761some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
762@end ifset
763
764The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
765@code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
766at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
767
768@cindex emulation
769@kindex -m @var{emulation}
2509a395 770@item -m @var{emulation}
252b5132
RH
771Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
772emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
773
774If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
775@code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
776
777Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
778configured.
779
780@cindex link map
781@kindex -M
782@kindex --print-map
783@item -M
784@itemx --print-map
785Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
786information about the link, including the following:
787
788@itemize @bullet
789@item
3b83e13a 790Where object files are mapped into memory.
252b5132
RH
791@item
792How common symbols are allocated.
793@item
794All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
795which caused the archive member to be brought in.
3b83e13a
NC
796@item
797The values assigned to symbols.
798
799Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
800involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
801have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
802linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
803of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
804the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
805linker script containing:
806
807@smallexample
808 foo = 1
809 foo = foo * 4
810 foo = foo + 8
811@end smallexample
812
813will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
814option is used:
815
816@smallexample
817 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
818 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
819 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
820@end smallexample
821
822See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
823scripts.
d2ef37eb 824
06ddcada
AM
825@item
826How GNU properties are merged.
d2ef37eb 827
06ddcada
AM
828When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
829.note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
830These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
d2ef37eb
L
831
832@smallexample
833Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
834@end smallexample
835
06ddcada 836This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
d2ef37eb
L
837merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
838is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
839
840@smallexample
06ddcada 841Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
d2ef37eb
L
842@end smallexample
843
06ddcada 844This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
d2ef37eb
L
845when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
846is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
252b5132
RH
847@end itemize
848
035801ce
FS
849@cindex link map discarded
850@kindex --print-map-discarded
851@kindex --no-print-map-discarded
852@item --print-map-discarded
853@itemx --no-print-map-discarded
854Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
855in the link map. Enabled by default.
856
252b5132
RH
857@kindex -n
858@cindex read-only text
859@cindex NMAGIC
860@kindex --nmagic
861@item -n
862@itemx --nmagic
90f5d9d9
JZ
863Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
864libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
865mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
252b5132
RH
866
867@kindex -N
868@kindex --omagic
869@cindex read/write from cmd line
870@cindex OMAGIC
a1ab1d2a 871@item -N
252b5132
RH
872@itemx --omagic
873Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
63fd3b82
NC
874not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
875libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
4d8907ac
DS
876mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
877is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
878specification published by Microsoft.
63fd3b82
NC
879
880@kindex --no-omagic
881@cindex OMAGIC
882@item --no-omagic
883This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
884sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
885be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
886shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
252b5132
RH
887
888@kindex -o @var{output}
889@kindex --output=@var{output}
890@cindex naming the output file
891@item -o @var{output}
892@itemx --output=@var{output}
ff5dcc92 893Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
252b5132
RH
894option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
895script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
896
f37b21b4
RM
897@kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
898@cindex dependency file
899@item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
900Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
901suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
902that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
903output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
904Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
905Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
906to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
907linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
908@samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
909installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
910distributed makefiles without careful editing.
911
252b5132
RH
912@kindex -O @var{level}
913@cindex generating optimized output
914@item -O @var{level}
ff5dcc92 915If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
252b5132 916the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
98c503ac
NC
917should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
918option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
919the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
920no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
921of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
252b5132 922
387dd777
DP
923@kindex -plugin @var{name}
924@item -plugin @var{name}
925Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
926the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
927automatically added by the complier, when using link time
928optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
929wish.
930
931Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
932from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
933@command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
934those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
41f37a6f 935copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
387dd777 936based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
6c19b93b 937just copy in the newest one.
387dd777 938
26278bb8
UD
939@kindex --push-state
940@cindex push state governing input file handling
941@item --push-state
942The @option{--push-state} allows to preserve the current state of the
943flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
944restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
945
946The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
947@option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
948@option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
949@option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
950@option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
951@option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
952
953One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
954used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
955listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
956something as follows:
957
958@smallexample
959-Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
960@end smallexample
961
962@kindex --pop-state
963@cindex pop state governing input file handling
67cecaba 964@item --pop-state
26278bb8
UD
965Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
966flags governing input file handling.
967
a712da20
NC
968@kindex -q
969@kindex --emit-relocs
970@cindex retain relocations in final executable
971@item -q
972@itemx --emit-relocs
ba1be17e 973Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
a712da20
NC
974Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
975order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
976in larger executables.
977
dbab7a7b
NC
978This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
979
4f471f39
RS
980@kindex --force-dynamic
981@cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
982@item --force-dynamic
983Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
984to VxWorks targets.
985
252b5132
RH
986@cindex partial link
987@cindex relocatable output
988@kindex -r
1049f94e 989@kindex --relocatable
252b5132 990@item -r
1049f94e 991@itemx --relocatable
252b5132 992Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 993turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
252b5132
RH
994linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
995magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
996@code{OMAGIC}.
ff5dcc92 997@c ; see @option{-N}.
252b5132
RH
998If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
999linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
1000constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1001
62bf86b4
HPN
1002When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1003partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1004relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1005example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1006with input files in other formats at all.
1007
252b5132
RH
1008This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1009
1010@kindex -R @var{file}
1011@kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1012@cindex symbol-only input
1013@item -R @var{filename}
1014@itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1015Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1016relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1017to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1018programs. You may use this option more than once.
1019
ff5dcc92 1020For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 1021followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 1022the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
1023
1024@kindex -s
1025@kindex --strip-all
1026@cindex strip all symbols
a1ab1d2a 1027@item -s
252b5132
RH
1028@itemx --strip-all
1029Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1030
1031@kindex -S
1032@kindex --strip-debug
1033@cindex strip debugger symbols
a1ab1d2a 1034@item -S
252b5132
RH
1035@itemx --strip-debug
1036Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1037
a70f34c0
NC
1038@kindex --strip-discarded
1039@kindex --no-strip-discarded
1040@item --strip-discarded
1041@itemx --no-strip-discarded
1042Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1043Enabled by default.
1044
252b5132
RH
1045@kindex -t
1046@kindex --trace
1047@cindex input files, displaying
a1ab1d2a 1048@item -t
252b5132 1049@itemx --trace
4f4690cd
AM
1050Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1051@samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1052@samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1053and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1054a linker bug report.
252b5132
RH
1055
1056@kindex -T @var{script}
1057@kindex --script=@var{script}
1058@cindex script files
1059@item -T @var{scriptfile}
1060@itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1061Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
ff5dcc92 1062@command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it), so
252b5132 1063@var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
114283d8
NC
1064output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1065the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1066specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1067options accumulate.
252b5132 1068
14be8564
L
1069@kindex -dT @var{script}
1070@kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1071@cindex script files
1072@item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1073@itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1074Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1075
1076This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1077processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1078command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1079@option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1080behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1081command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1082the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1083@samp{gcc}).
1084
252b5132
RH
1085@kindex -u @var{symbol}
1086@kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1087@cindex undefined symbol
1088@item -u @var{symbol}
1089@itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1090Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1091symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1092modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1093different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1094option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1095
0a618243
AB
1096If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1097into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1098undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1099instead.
1100
1101@kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1102@cindex symbols, require defined
1103@cindex defined symbol
1104@item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1105Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1106is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1107is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1108and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1109@code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1110can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1111
252b5132
RH
1112@kindex -Ur
1113@cindex constructors
a1ab1d2a 1114@item -Ur
252b5132
RH
1115For anything other than C++ programs, this option is equivalent to
1116@samp{-r}: it generates relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 1117turn serve as input to @command{ld}. When linking C++ programs, @samp{-Ur}
252b5132
RH
1118@emph{does} resolve references to constructors, unlike @samp{-r}.
1119It does not work to use @samp{-Ur} on files that were themselves linked
1120with @samp{-Ur}; once the constructor table has been built, it cannot
1121be added to. Use @samp{-Ur} only for the last partial link, and
1122@samp{-r} for the others.
1123
c005eb9e
AB
1124@kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1125@cindex orphan sections
1126@cindex sections, orphan
1127@item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1128Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1129specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1130
1131@var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1132
1133@table @code
1134@item place
1135Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1136the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
d2732b69 1137@samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
c005eb9e
AB
1138
1139@item discard
1140All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1141@samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1142
1143@item warn
1144The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1145issue a warning.
1146
1147@item error
1148The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1149@end table
1150
1151The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1152
577a0623
AM
1153@kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1154@item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1155Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1156@var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1157missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1158specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1159multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1160input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1161in a linker script.
a854a4a7 1162
252b5132
RH
1163@kindex -v
1164@kindex -V
1165@kindex --version
1166@cindex version
1167@item -v
1168@itemx --version
1169@itemx -V
ff5dcc92 1170Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
252b5132
RH
1171lists the supported emulations.
1172
1173@kindex -x
1174@kindex --discard-all
1175@cindex deleting local symbols
1176@item -x
1177@itemx --discard-all
1178Delete all local symbols.
1179
1180@kindex -X
1181@kindex --discard-locals
1182@cindex local symbols, deleting
a1ab1d2a 1183@item -X
252b5132 1184@itemx --discard-locals
3c68c38f
BW
1185Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1186system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1187or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
252b5132
RH
1188
1189@kindex -y @var{symbol}
1190@kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1191@cindex symbol tracing
1192@item -y @var{symbol}
1193@itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1194Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1195option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1196to prepend an underscore.
1197
1198This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1199don't know where the reference is coming from.
1200
1201@kindex -Y @var{path}
1202@item -Y @var{path}
1203Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1204for Solaris compatibility.
1205
1206@kindex -z @var{keyword}
1207@item -z @var{keyword}
cd6d6c15
NC
1208The recognized keywords are:
1209@table @samp
1210
e6e2dfbd
AM
1211@item bndplt
1212Always generate BND prefix in PLT entries. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1213
1214@item call-nop=prefix-addr
1215@itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1216@itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1217@itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1218Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1219to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1220@option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1221@option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1222@option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1223@option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1224Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1225
233a0083
L
1226@item cet-report=none
1227@itemx cet-report=warning
1228@itemx cet-report=error
1229Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1230GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1231section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1232linker not report missing properties in input files.
1233@option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1234missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1235the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1236Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1237GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1238turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1239Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1240
cd6d6c15 1241@item combreloc
e6e2dfbd
AM
1242@itemx nocombreloc
1243Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1244dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
cd6d6c15 1245
b8871f35 1246@item common
e6e2dfbd
AM
1247@itemx nocommon
1248Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1249link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1250
1251@item common-page-size=@var{value}
1252Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1253layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1254using pages of this size.
b8871f35 1255
cd6d6c15 1256@item defs
97a232d7
NC
1257Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1258is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1259This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
cd6d6c15 1260
e6e2dfbd
AM
1261@item dynamic-undefined-weak
1262@itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1263Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1264if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1265by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1266@samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1267may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1268selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1269these options.
1270
6aa29e7b
JJ
1271@item execstack
1272Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1273
b039ef04
L
1274@item global
1275This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1276the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1277of subsequently loaded libraries.
1278
93ab9c0d
NC
1279@item globalaudit
1280This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1281This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1282setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1283tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
a05a5b64 1284the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
6c19b93b 1285all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
93ab9c0d 1286
e6e2dfbd
AM
1287@item ibtplt
1288Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1289Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1290
8df93cb5 1291@item ibt
e6e2dfbd
AM
1292Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1293to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1294Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1295
cd6d6c15
NC
1296@item initfirst
1297This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1298It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1299before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1300the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1301the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1302objects.
1303
1304@item interpose
e6e2dfbd
AM
1305Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1306so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1307libraries not so marked.
cd6d6c15 1308
5fa222e4
AM
1309@item lazy
1310When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1311dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1312the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1313Lazy binding is the default.
1314
cd6d6c15 1315@item loadfltr
e6e2dfbd 1316Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
cd6d6c15 1317
e6e2dfbd
AM
1318@item max-page-size=@var{value}
1319Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
cd6d6c15 1320
e6e2dfbd
AM
1321@item muldefs
1322Allow multiple definitions.
b8871f35 1323
cd6d6c15 1324@item nocopyreloc
daf220f0
AM
1325Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1326defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
cd6d6c15
NC
1327
1328@item nodefaultlib
e6e2dfbd
AM
1329Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1330should ignore any default library search paths.
cd6d6c15
NC
1331
1332@item nodelete
e6e2dfbd 1333Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
cd6d6c15
NC
1334
1335@item nodlopen
e6e2dfbd 1336Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
cd6d6c15
NC
1337
1338@item nodump
e6e2dfbd 1339Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
cd6d6c15 1340
6aa29e7b
JJ
1341@item noexecstack
1342Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1343
e6e2dfbd
AM
1344@item noextern-protected-data
1345Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1346library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1347used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1348generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1349module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1350i386 and x86-64.
8dfef1bd 1351
e6e2dfbd
AM
1352@item noreloc-overflow
1353Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1354relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1355overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
6aa29e7b 1356
cd6d6c15
NC
1357@item now
1358When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1359dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
e6e2dfbd
AM
1360when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1361function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1362called.
cd6d6c15
NC
1363
1364@item origin
e6e2dfbd 1365Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
cd6d6c15 1366
6aa29e7b 1367@item relro
e6e2dfbd 1368@itemx norelro
def5c83c
AM
1369Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1370specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1371relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1372than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
e6e2dfbd 1373Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
6aa29e7b 1374
47acac12
L
1375@item separate-code
1376@itemx noseparate-code
1377Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1378specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1379be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1380code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1381
496afd17
L
1382@item unique-symbol
1383@itemx nounique-symbol
1384Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1385".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1386is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1387
e6e2dfbd
AM
1388@item shstk
1389Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1390to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1391Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
24718e3b 1392
04c3a755 1393@item stack-size=@var{value}
e6e2dfbd 1394Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
04c3a755
NS
1395Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1396@code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1397
cae64165
RM
1398@item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1399@cindex visibility
1400@cindex ELF symbol visibility
1401Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1402@code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1403Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1404@samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1405start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1406compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1407recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1408programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1409between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1410
e6e2dfbd
AM
1411@item text
1412@itemx notext
1413@itemx textoff
a6dbf402
L
1414Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1415or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1416report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
48580982 1417
97a232d7
NC
1418@item undefs
1419Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1420either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1421This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1422
b0ab0693 1423@item x86-64-baseline
32930e4e
L
1424@item x86-64-v2
1425@item x86-64-v3
1426@itemx x86-64-v4
1427Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
b0ab0693 1428@option{x86-64-baseline} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_BASELINE}.
32930e4e
L
1429@option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1430@option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1431@option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1432Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1433
cd6d6c15
NC
1434@end table
1435
ece2d90e 1436Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
252b5132
RH
1437
1438@kindex -(
1439@cindex groups of archives
1440@item -( @var{archives} -)
1441@itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1442The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1443either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1444
1445The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1446references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1447the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1448archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1449object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1450would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
5d3db3e2 1451they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
252b5132
RH
1452resolved.
1453
1454Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1455it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1456more archives.
1457
69da35b5
NC
1458@kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1459@kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1460@item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1461@itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1462Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
2ca22b03 1463recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
69da35b5
NC
1464and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1465the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1466behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1467so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1468restore the old behaviour.
2ca22b03 1469
4a43e768
AM
1470@kindex --as-needed
1471@kindex --no-as-needed
1472@item --as-needed
1473@itemx --no-as-needed
1474This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
ddbb8a31 1475on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
4a43e768
AM
1476the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1477on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
ddbb8a31 1478needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
ffa9430d
AM
1479emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1480non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1240be6b
AM
1481the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1482non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
ffa9430d
AM
1483Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1484the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1485needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1486from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
4a43e768 1487
e56f61be
L
1488@kindex --add-needed
1489@kindex --no-add-needed
1490@item --add-needed
1491@itemx --no-add-needed
ddbb8a31
NC
1492These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1493their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1494options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1495and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
e56f61be 1496
252b5132
RH
1497@kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1498@item -assert @var{keyword}
1499This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1500
1501@kindex -Bdynamic
1502@kindex -dy
1503@kindex -call_shared
1504@item -Bdynamic
1505@itemx -dy
1506@itemx -call_shared
1507Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1508for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1509default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1510for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1511multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
da8bce14 1512@option{-l} options which follow it.
252b5132 1513
a1ab1d2a
UD
1514@kindex -Bgroup
1515@item -Bgroup
1516Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1517section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1518object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
560e09e9
NC
1519@option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1520only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
a1ab1d2a 1521
252b5132
RH
1522@kindex -Bstatic
1523@kindex -dn
1524@kindex -non_shared
1525@kindex -static
a1ab1d2a 1526@item -Bstatic
252b5132
RH
1527@itemx -dn
1528@itemx -non_shared
1529@itemx -static
1530Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1531platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1532variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1533may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
560e09e9 1534library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
e9156f74
NC
1535option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1536option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1537shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1538references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
ece2d90e 1539libraries.
252b5132
RH
1540
1541@kindex -Bsymbolic
1542@item -Bsymbolic
1543When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1544definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1545for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1914e264
AM
1546within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1547platforms which support shared libraries.
252b5132 1548
40b36307
L
1549@kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1550@item -Bsymbolic-functions
1551When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
c0065db7 1552symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
40b36307 1553This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1914e264 1554libraries.
40b36307 1555
55255dae
L
1556@kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1557@item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1558Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1559typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1560global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1561within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1562to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1563in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1564which support shared libraries.
1565
1566The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1567scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1568
40b36307
L
1569@kindex --dynamic-list-data
1570@item --dynamic-list-data
1571Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1572
1573@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1574@item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1575Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1576is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1577
0b8a70d9
L
1578@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1579@item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1580Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1581
252b5132
RH
1582@kindex --check-sections
1583@kindex --no-check-sections
1584@item --check-sections
308b1ffd 1585@itemx --no-check-sections
252b5132 1586Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
7d816a17 1587been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
252b5132
RH
1588perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1589suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1590allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
a05a5b64 1591restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
02b0b1aa
NS
1592Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1593force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1594option.
252b5132 1595
ddbb8a31
NC
1596@kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1597@kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1598@item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1599@itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
9d5777a3 1600This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
ddbb8a31 1601by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
08efffb8 1602command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
ddbb8a31 1603output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
08efffb8 1604input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
ddbb8a31 1605specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
08efffb8
MM
1606follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1607behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
ddbb8a31
NC
1608
1609This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
08efffb8
MM
1610libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1611mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1612their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1613required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1614the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1615dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
ddbb8a31
NC
1616symbols.
1617
252b5132
RH
1618@cindex cross reference table
1619@kindex --cref
1620@item --cref
1621Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1622generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1623Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1624
1625The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1626easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1627sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1628symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
049c1c8e
NC
1629definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1630where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1631symbol are listed.
252b5132 1632
5dba6f05
NA
1633@cindex ctf variables
1634@kindex --ctf-variables
1635@kindex --no-ctf-variables
1636@item --ctf-variables
1637@item --no-ctf-variables
1638The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1639types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1640table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1641conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1642usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1643@option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1644The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1645
1646@cindex ctf type sharing
1647@kindex --ctf-share-types
1648@item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1649Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1650
1651@table @samp
1652@item share-unconflicted
1653Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1654where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1655translation unit. This is the default.
1656
1657@item share-duplicated
1658Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1659dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1660dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1661always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1662larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1663large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1664consumer at runtime.
1665@end table
1666
4818e05f
AM
1667@cindex common allocation
1668@kindex --no-define-common
1669@item --no-define-common
1670This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1671The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1672@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1673
1674The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1675the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1676of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1677forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1678Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1679from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1680This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1681and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1682duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1683paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1684
7bdf4127
AB
1685@cindex group allocation in linker script
1686@cindex section groups
1687@cindex COMDAT
1688@kindex --force-group-allocation
1689@item --force-group-allocation
1690This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1691normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1692default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1693change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1694command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1695effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1696
252b5132 1697@cindex symbols, from command line
2509a395
SL
1698@kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1699@item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
252b5132
RH
1700Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1701address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1702times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1703limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1704context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1705symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1706constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
66bc8739
AM
1707using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1708@emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1709equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
252b5132 1710
54874444
AB
1711The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments
1712in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the
1713symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while
1714placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after
1715the linker script has been processed. This difference has
1716consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the
1717@samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what
1718you are trying to achieve.
1719
252b5132 1720@cindex demangling, from command line
28c309a2 1721@kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132 1722@kindex --no-demangle
28c309a2 1723@item --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132
RH
1724@itemx --no-demangle
1725These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1726and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1727present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1728underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
a1ab1d2a
UD
1729mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1730different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1731to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
28c309a2
NC
1732demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1733is set. These options may be used to override the default.
252b5132
RH
1734
1735@cindex dynamic linker, from command line
506eee22 1736@kindex -I@var{file}
2509a395
SL
1737@kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1738@item -I@var{file}
1739@itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
252b5132
RH
1740Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1741generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1742linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1743doing.
1744
9b8b325a
RF
1745@kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1746@item --no-dynamic-linker
1747When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1748linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1749executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1750entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1751
a70f34c0
NC
1752@kindex --embedded-relocs
1753@item --embedded-relocs
1754This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
a094d01f 1755that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
a70f34c0
NC
1756is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1757targets.
1758
3f0a5f17
ME
1759@kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1760@item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1761Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1762in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1763
7ce691ae 1764@kindex --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd 1765@kindex --no-fatal-warnings
7ce691ae 1766@item --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd
NC
1767@itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1768Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1769with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
7ce691ae 1770
252b5132
RH
1771@kindex --force-exe-suffix
1772@item --force-exe-suffix
1773Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1774
1775If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1776@code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1777the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1778option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1779Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1780it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1781
1782@kindex --gc-sections
1783@kindex --no-gc-sections
1784@cindex garbage collection
c17d87de
NC
1785@item --gc-sections
1786@itemx --no-gc-sections
252b5132 1787Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
ac69cbc6 1788targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
b3549761 1789performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
0f088b2a
KT
1790@samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
1791collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
1792implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
252b5132 1793
d5465ba2
AM
1794@samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
1795examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
1796symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
1797command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
1798referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
1799libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
1800referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
1801the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
b69e1ff3
CC
1802relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
1803@samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
d5465ba2 1804
ac69cbc6 1805This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
9d5777a3 1806@samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
b69e1ff3
CC
1807specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
1808@samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
1809command in the linker script.
ac69cbc6 1810
99fabbc9
JL
1811As a GNU extension, ELF input sections marked with the
1812@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN} flag will not be garbage collected.
1813
c17d87de
NC
1814@kindex --print-gc-sections
1815@kindex --no-print-gc-sections
1816@cindex garbage collection
1817@item --print-gc-sections
1818@itemx --no-print-gc-sections
1819List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
1820printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
1821collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
1822default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
1823be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
1824line.
1825
22185505 1826@kindex --gc-keep-exported
1827@cindex garbage collection
1828@item --gc-keep-exported
1829When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
1830collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
1831default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
1832executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
1833collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
1834Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
1835it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
1836ELF format targets.
1837
30824704
RM
1838@kindex --print-output-format
1839@cindex output format
1840@item --print-output-format
1841Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
1842other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
1843in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
1844
3604cb1f
TG
1845@kindex --print-memory-usage
1846@cindex memory usage
1847@item --print-memory-usage
1848Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
1849the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
1850quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
1851headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
1852parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
1853
1854@smallexample
1855Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
1856 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
1857 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
1858@end smallexample
1859
252b5132
RH
1860@cindex help
1861@cindex usage
1862@kindex --help
1863@item --help
1864Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
1865
ea20a7da
CC
1866@kindex --target-help
1867@item --target-help
a094d01f 1868Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
ea20a7da 1869
2509a395
SL
1870@kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
1871@item -Map=@var{mapfile}
252b5132 1872Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
2c72361c
NC
1873@option{-M} option, above. If @var{mapfile} is just the character
1874@code{-} then the map will be written to stdout.
1875
1876Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile} causes the linker map to be
1877written as a file inside the directory. Normally name of the file
1878inside the directory is computed as the basename of the @var{output}
1879file with @code{.map} appended. If however the special character
1880@code{%} is used then this will be replaced by the full path of the
1881output file. Additionally if there are any characters after the
1882@var{%} symbol then @code{.map} will no longer be appended.
1883
1884@smallexample
1885 -o foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1886 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1887 -o foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1888 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1889 -o foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ./foo.exe.map]
1890 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1891 -o foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ./foo.exe.bar]
1892 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.bar]
1893 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/% [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.map]
1894 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%.bar [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.bar]
1895@end smallexample
1896
1897It is an error to specify more than one @code{%} character.
1898
1899If the map file already exists then it will be overwritten by this
1900operation.
252b5132
RH
1901
1902@cindex memory usage
1903@kindex --no-keep-memory
1904@item --no-keep-memory
ff5dcc92
SC
1905@command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
1906symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
252b5132 1907instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
ff5dcc92 1908necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
252b5132
RH
1909while linking a large executable.
1910
1911@kindex --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 1912@kindex -z defs
97a232d7 1913@kindex -z undefs
252b5132 1914@item --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 1915@itemx -z defs
560e09e9
NC
1916Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1917is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1918The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
1919behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
ece2d90e 1920libraries being linked in.
252b5132 1921
97a232d7
NC
1922The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
1923
aa713662
L
1924@kindex --allow-multiple-definition
1925@kindex -z muldefs
1926@item --allow-multiple-definition
1927@itemx -z muldefs
1928Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
1929report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
1930first definition will be used.
1931
b79e8c78 1932@kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 1933@kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
b79e8c78 1934@item --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 1935@itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
903249d7 1936Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
560e09e9
NC
1937This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
1938determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
1939shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
1940how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
1941
903249d7
NC
1942The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
1943referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
1944an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
1945a shared library.
1946
1947The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
1948libraries specified at link time are that:
1949
1950@itemize @bullet
1951@item
1952A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
1953that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
1954resolvable at load time.
1955@item
1956There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
1957symbols in shared libraries are normal.
1958
1959The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
1960select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
1961architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
1962appropriate memset function.
1963@end itemize
b79e8c78 1964
23ae20f5
NC
1965@kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
1966@item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
1967If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
1968@var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered. Currently however
1969only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
1970libraries. Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
93cf38c0
NC
1971``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
1972undefined symbol or missing library. The intention is that the script
1973will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
23ae20f5
NC
1974might be found. After the script has finished then the normal linker
1975error message will be displayed.
1976
1977The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
1978switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
1979
31941635
L
1980@kindex --no-undefined-version
1981@item --no-undefined-version
1982Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
1983it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
1984will be issued instead.
1985
3e3b46e5
PB
1986@kindex --default-symver
1987@item --default-symver
1988Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
fc0e6df6
PB
1989exported symbols.
1990
1991@kindex --default-imported-symver
1992@item --default-imported-symver
1993Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
1994imported symbols.
3e3b46e5 1995
252b5132
RH
1996@kindex --no-warn-mismatch
1997@item --no-warn-mismatch
ff5dcc92 1998Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
252b5132
RH
1999files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
2000been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
ff5dcc92 2001This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
252b5132
RH
2002errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
2003have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
2004inappropriate.
2005
fe7929ce
AM
2006@kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
2007@item --no-warn-search-mismatch
2008Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
2009library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
2010
252b5132
RH
2011@kindex --no-whole-archive
2012@item --no-whole-archive
ff5dcc92 2013Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
252b5132
RH
2014archive files.
2015
2016@cindex output file after errors
2017@kindex --noinhibit-exec
2018@item --noinhibit-exec
2019Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
2020Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
2021errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
2022when it issues any error whatsoever.
2023
0a9c1c8e
CD
2024@kindex -nostdlib
2025@item -nostdlib
2026Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
2027command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
2028(including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
2029
252b5132 2030@ifclear SingleFormat
2509a395
SL
2031@kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
2032@item --oformat=@var{output-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
2033@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
2034file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 2035@samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
ff5dcc92
SC
2036object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
2037object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
2038should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2039usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2040name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
2041list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
2042command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2043this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
2044@end ifclear
2045
76359541
TP
2046@kindex --out-implib
2047@item --out-implib @var{file}
2048Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2049the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
2050library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2051may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2052behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2053step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
2054the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2055
36af4a4e
JJ
2056@kindex -pie
2057@kindex --pic-executable
2058@item -pie
2059@itemx --pic-executable
2060@cindex position independent executables
2061Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
2062ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2063libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
7e7d5768 2064address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
36af4a4e
JJ
2065normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2066defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2067
252b5132
RH
2068@kindex -qmagic
2069@item -qmagic
2070This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2071
2072@kindex -Qy
2073@item -Qy
2074This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2075
2076@kindex --relax
2077@cindex synthesizing linker
2078@cindex relaxing addressing modes
28d5f677 2079@cindex --no-relax
252b5132 2080@item --relax
28d5f677 2081@itemx --no-relax
a1ab1d2a 2082An option with machine dependent effects.
252b5132
RH
2083@ifset GENERIC
2084This option is only supported on a few targets.
2085@end ifset
2086@ifset H8300
ff5dcc92 2087@xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
252b5132 2088@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
2089@ifset XTENSA
2090@xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2091@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
2092@ifset M68HC11
2093@xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2094@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
2095@ifset NIOSII
2096@xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2097@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
2098@ifset POWERPC
2099@xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2100@end ifset
252b5132 2101
ccd9fae5 2102On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
28d5f677
NC
2103global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2104addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2105synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
11e7fd74 2106instructions, and combining constant values.
252b5132
RH
2107
2108On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2109debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2110@ifset GENERIC
28d5f677
NC
2111This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2112family of processors.
252b5132
RH
2113@end ifset
2114
ccd9fae5
NC
2115On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2116@option{--no-relax} will disable it.
28d5f677 2117
ccd9fae5
NC
2118On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2119and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
2120
252b5132
RH
2121@cindex retaining specified symbols
2122@cindex stripping all but some symbols
2123@cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2509a395
SL
2124@kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2125@item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
252b5132
RH
2126Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2127discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2128symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2129@ifset GENERIC
2130(such as VxWorks)
2131@end ifset
2132where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2133run-time memory.
2134
2135@samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2136or symbols needed for relocations.
2137
2138You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2139line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2140
2141@ifset GENERIC
2509a395 2142@item -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2143@cindex runtime library search path
2509a395 2144@kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2145Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
ff5dcc92 2146linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
252b5132 2147arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
c1b00498
MR
2148them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2149
2150The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2151are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2152description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2153in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2154have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2155
2156If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2157contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2158is defined.
252b5132 2159
ff5dcc92 2160The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
d8506323 2161SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
ff5dcc92
SC
2162@option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2163runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2164options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2165gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
b45619c0 2166file systems.
252b5132 2167
ff5dcc92 2168For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 2169followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 2170the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
2171@end ifset
2172
2173@ifset GENERIC
2174@cindex link-time runtime library search path
2509a395
SL
2175@kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2176@item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
252b5132
RH
2177When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2178happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2179of the input files.
2180
2181When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2182non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2183shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
ff5dcc92 2184explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
252b5132 2185specifies the first set of directories to search. The
ff5dcc92 2186@option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
252b5132
RH
2187either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2188appearing multiple times.
2189
e680a6b6
NC
2190The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2191directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2192containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2193and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
219464-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2195
2196The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2197@var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2198supported.
2199
28c309a2
NC
2200This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2201that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2202is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2203runtime linker would do.
2204
252b5132 2205The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
ece2d90e 2206libraries:
d8e4137b 2207
252b5132
RH
2208@enumerate
2209@item
ff5dcc92 2210Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
252b5132 2211@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2212Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2213between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2214specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2215used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
ece2d90e
NC
2216at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2217by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2218the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
252b5132 2219@item
e2a83dd0
NC
2220On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2221@option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2222environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
252b5132 2223@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2224On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2225directories specified using @option{-L} options.
252b5132 2226@item
a1b8d843 2227For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
e2a83dd0 2228variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
252b5132 2229@item
ec4eb78a
L
2230For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2231@code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2232libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2233@code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2234@item
252b5132
RH
2235The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2236@item
d8e4137b
NC
2237For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2238exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2239to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2240defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2241configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2242@item
2243For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2244the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2245header file.
2246@item
2247Any directories specifed by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in the
2248linker script being used.
252b5132
RH
2249@end enumerate
2250
2251If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2252warning and continue with the link.
2253@end ifset
2254
2255@kindex -shared
2256@kindex -Bshareable
2257@item -shared
2258@itemx -Bshareable
2259@cindex shared libraries
2260Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2261and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
ff5dcc92 2262shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
252b5132
RH
2263undefined symbols in the link.
2264
252b5132 2265@kindex --sort-common
2509a395
SL
2266@item --sort-common
2267@itemx --sort-common=ascending
2268@itemx --sort-common=descending
de7dd2bd
NC
2269This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2270ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2271sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2272eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2273between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2274specified, then descending order is assumed.
252b5132 2275
2509a395
SL
2276@kindex --sort-section=name
2277@item --sort-section=name
bcaa7b3e
L
2278This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2279patterns in the linker script.
2280
2509a395
SL
2281@kindex --sort-section=alignment
2282@item --sort-section=alignment
bcaa7b3e
L
2283This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2284patterns in the linker script.
2285
a70f34c0
NC
2286@kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2287@item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2288This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2289.dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2290post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2291
252b5132 2292@kindex --split-by-file
2509a395 2293@item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
ff5dcc92 2294Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
a854a4a7
AM
2295each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2296size of 1 if not given.
252b5132
RH
2297
2298@kindex --split-by-reloc
2509a395 2299@item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
a854a4a7 2300Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
252b5132 2301output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
a854a4a7 2302This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
252b5132
RH
2303certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2304cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2305that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2306support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2307input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2308more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
a854a4a7 2309many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
252b5132
RH
2310
2311@kindex --stats
2312@item --stats
2313Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2314as execution time and memory usage.
2315
2509a395 2316@kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
e2243057
RS
2317@item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2318Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2319configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2320that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2321
a70f34c0
NC
2322@kindex --task-link
2323@item --task-link
2324This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2325file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2326
252b5132
RH
2327@kindex --traditional-format
2328@cindex traditional format
2329@item --traditional-format
ff5dcc92
SC
2330For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2331the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
252b5132
RH
2332use the traditional format instead.
2333
2334@cindex dbx
ff5dcc92 2335For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
252b5132
RH
2336symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2337full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2338@code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
ff5dcc92 2339trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
252b5132
RH
2340combine duplicate entries.
2341
2509a395
SL
2342@kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2343@item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
176355da
NC
2344Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2345address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2346times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2347line.
2348@var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2349for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2350@samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2351should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2352sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2353
2509a395
SL
2354@kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2355@kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2356@kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
252b5132 2357@cindex segment origins, cmd line
2509a395
SL
2358@item -Tbss=@var{org}
2359@itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2360@itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2361Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
a6e02871 2362@code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
252b5132 2363
2509a395
SL
2364@kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2365@item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
258795f5 2366@cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2b8c06a3
L
2367When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2368byte of the text segment.
258795f5 2369
9d5777a3
RM
2370@kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2371@item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2372@cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2373When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2374the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2375text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2376
0d705e9f
AM
2377@kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2378@item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2379@cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2380When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2381model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2382
560e09e9
NC
2383@kindex --unresolved-symbols
2384@item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2385Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2386values for @samp{method}:
2387
2388@table @samp
2389@item ignore-all
da8bce14 2390Do not report any unresolved symbols.
560e09e9
NC
2391
2392@item report-all
da8bce14 2393Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
560e09e9
NC
2394
2395@item ignore-in-object-files
2396Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2397ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2398
2399@item ignore-in-shared-libs
2400Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2401ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2402when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2403libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2404command line.
2405@end table
2406
2407The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2408by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2409
2410Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2411unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2412can change this to a warning.
2413
1715a13c
L
2414@kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2415@cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
252b5132 2416@item --dll-verbose
1715a13c 2417@itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
ff5dcc92 2418Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
252b5132 2419supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
1715a13c
L
2420the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2421argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
252b5132
RH
2422
2423@kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2424@cindex version script, symbol versions
2509a395 2425@item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
252b5132
RH
2426Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2427used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
36f63dca 2428about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
09e2aba4
DK
2429is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2430see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2431use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2432symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2433@xref{WIN32}.
252b5132 2434
7ce691ae 2435@kindex --warn-common
252b5132
RH
2436@cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2437@cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2438@item --warn-common
2439Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
11e7fd74 2440a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
252b5132
RH
2441but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2442you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
11e7fd74 2443Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
252b5132
RH
2444warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2445
2446There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2447
2448@table @samp
2449@item int i = 1;
2450A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2451file.
2452
2453@item extern int i;
2454An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2455There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2456variable somewhere.
2457
2458@item int i;
2459A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2460variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2461The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2462single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2463size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2464a definition of the same variable.
2465@end table
2466
2467The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2468Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2469just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2470encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2471a common symbol.
2472
2473@enumerate
2474@item
2475Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2476definition for the symbol.
2477@smallexample
2478@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2479 overridden by definition
2480@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2481@end smallexample
2482
2483@item
2484Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2485the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2486except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2487@smallexample
2488@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2489 overriding common
2490@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2491@end smallexample
2492
2493@item
2494Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2495@smallexample
2496@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2497 of `@var{symbol}'
2498@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2499@end smallexample
2500
2501@item
2502Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2503@smallexample
2504@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2505 overridden by larger common
2506@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2507@end smallexample
2508
2509@item
2510Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2511the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2512encountered in a different order.
2513@smallexample
2514@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2515 overriding smaller common
2516@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2517@end smallexample
2518@end enumerate
2519
2520@kindex --warn-constructors
2521@item --warn-constructors
2522Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2523object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2524detect the use of global constructors.
2525
2526@kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2527@item --warn-multiple-gp
2528Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2529This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2530Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2531section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2532of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2533base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2534base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2535bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2536large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2537values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2538option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2539
2540@kindex --warn-once
2541@cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2542@cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2543@item --warn-once
2544Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2545which refers to it.
2546
2547@kindex --warn-section-align
2548@cindex warnings, on section alignment
2549@cindex section alignment, warnings on
2550@item --warn-section-align
2551Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2552alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2553The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2554is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2555the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2556
a6dbf402
L
2557@kindex --warn-textrel
2558@item --warn-textrel
2559Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2560or shared object.
8fdd7217 2561
a0c402a5
L
2562@kindex --warn-alternate-em
2563@item --warn-alternate-em
2564Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2565
560e09e9
NC
2566@kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2567@item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2568If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2569@option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2570This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2571
2572@kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2573@item --error-unresolved-symbols
2574This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2575it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2576
252b5132
RH
2577@kindex --whole-archive
2578@cindex including an entire archive
2579@item --whole-archive
2580For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
ff5dcc92 2581@option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
252b5132
RH
2582in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2583files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2584library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2585library. This option may be used more than once.
2586
7ec229ce 2587Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
ff5dcc92
SC
2588about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2589Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
7ec229ce
DD
2590list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2591your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2592
2509a395
SL
2593@kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2594@item --wrap=@var{symbol}
252b5132
RH
2595Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2596@var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2597undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2598@var{symbol}.
2599
2600This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2601wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2602wishes to call the system function, it should call
2603@code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2604
2605Here is a trivial example:
2606
2607@smallexample
2608void *
cc2f008e 2609__wrap_malloc (size_t c)
252b5132 2610@{
cc2f008e 2611 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
252b5132
RH
2612 return __real_malloc (c);
2613@}
2614@end smallexample
2615
ff5dcc92 2616If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
252b5132
RH
2617all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2618instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2619call the real @code{malloc} function.
2620
2621You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
ff5dcc92 2622links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
252b5132
RH
2623you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2624file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2625call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2626
4ea904ed
SH
2627Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2628internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2629@code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2630@code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2631
2632@smallexample
2633int
2634f (void)
2635@{
2636 return 123;
2637@}
2638
2639int
2640g (void)
2641@{
2642 return f();
2643@}
2644@end smallexample
2645
6aa29e7b 2646@kindex --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b 2647@kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
6aa29e7b 2648@item --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b
NC
2649@itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2650Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2651(@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2652section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
6aa29e7b 2653
e41b3a13
JJ
2654@kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2655@item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2656Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2657generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
2658if linker generated unwind info is supported.
2659
6c1439be
L
2660@kindex --enable-new-dtags
2661@kindex --disable-new-dtags
2662@item --enable-new-dtags
2663@itemx --disable-new-dtags
2664This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2665systems may not understand them. If you specify
b1b00fcc
MF
2666@option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2667and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
ff5dcc92 2668If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
6c1439be
L
2669created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2670those options are only available for ELF systems.
2671
2d643429 2672@kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
e185dd51 2673@item --hash-size=@var{number}
2d643429
NC
2674Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2675close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2676time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2677increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2678value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2679
fdc90cb4
JJ
2680@kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2681@item --hash-style=@var{style}
2682Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2683@code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2684new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2685the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
c8455dc9
NC
2686hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2687but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
fdc90cb4 2688
0ce398f1
L
2689@kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2690@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2691@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2692@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2693@item --compress-debug-sections=none
2694@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2695@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2696@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
9af89fba
NC
2697On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2698compressed using zlib.
2699
2700@option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2701sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2702DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2703instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2704also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2705sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2706
2707The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2708@option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2709
2710Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2711sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2712for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2713uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2714
2715The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
2716involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
2717default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
2718@option{--help} option.
0ce398f1 2719
35835446
JR
2720@kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
2721@item --reduce-memory-overheads
2722This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
f2a8f148 2723linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
35835446 2724for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2d643429
NC
2725about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
2726
4f9c04f7 2727Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2d643429 27281021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
a85785bc 2729run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2d643429
NC
2730has been used.
2731
2732The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
2733enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
35835446 2734
c0065db7
RM
2735@kindex --build-id
2736@kindex --build-id=@var{style}
2737@item --build-id
2738@itemx --build-id=@var{style}
61e2488c 2739Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
6033bf41 2740or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
61e2488c
JT
2741unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
2742@code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
2743@sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
2744@code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
2745the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
2746string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
2747@code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
2748is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
24382dca
RM
2749
2750The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
2751that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
2752unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
2753to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
2754file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
2755string identifying the original linked file does not change.
c0065db7
RM
2756
2757Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
2758@code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
252b5132
RH
2759@end table
2760
0285c67d
NC
2761@c man end
2762
36f63dca 2763@subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
252b5132 2764
0285c67d
NC
2765@c man begin OPTIONS
2766
ff5dcc92 2767The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
252b5132
RH
2768the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
2769normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
2770use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
2771@code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
2772like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
2773symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
2774object file).
2775
2776In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
a05a5b64 2777support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
252b5132
RH
2778PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
2779values by either a space or an equals sign.
2780
ff5dcc92 2781@table @gcctabopt
252b5132
RH
2782
2783@kindex --add-stdcall-alias
2784@item --add-stdcall-alias
2785If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
2786as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
bb10df36 2787[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2788
2789@kindex --base-file
2790@item --base-file @var{file}
2791Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
2792addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
2793@file{dlltool}.
bb10df36 2794[This is an i386 PE specific option]
252b5132
RH
2795
2796@kindex --dll
2797@item --dll
2798Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
ff5dcc92 2799@option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
252b5132 2800file.
bb10df36 2801[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2802
88183869
DK
2803@kindex --enable-long-section-names
2804@kindex --disable-long-section-names
2805@item --enable-long-section-names
2806@itemx --disable-long-section-names
56e6cf80 2807The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
88183869 2808the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
56e6cf80
NC
2809for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
2810fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
88183869
DK
2811to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
2812allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
2813disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
2814generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
2815as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
9d5777a3
RM
2816with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
2817GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
3efd345c
DK
2818information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
2819option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
2820section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
2821when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
2822image and not stripping symbols.
88183869
DK
2823[This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
2824
252b5132
RH
2825@kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
2826@kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
2827@item --enable-stdcall-fixup
2828@itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
2829If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
36f63dca 2830do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
252b5132
RH
2831only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
2832resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
2833undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
2834@code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
2835to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
2836warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
2837import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
ff5dcc92 2838to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
252b5132 2839feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
ff5dcc92 2840@option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
252b5132 2841mismatches are considered to be errors.
bb10df36 2842[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2843
522f09cd
KT
2844@kindex --leading-underscore
2845@kindex --no-leading-underscore
2846@item --leading-underscore
2847@itemx --no-leading-underscore
2848For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
2849in target's description. By this option it is possible to
2850disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
2851
252b5132
RH
2852@cindex DLLs, creating
2853@kindex --export-all-symbols
2854@item --export-all-symbols
2855If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
2856be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
2857otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
2858explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
2859attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
2860option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
ece2d90e 2861@code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
b044cda1 2862@code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
ece2d90e
NC
2863exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
2864re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
2865such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
2866@code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
b044cda1
CW
2867@code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
2868Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
2869not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
ece2d90e 2870extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
b044cda1 2871(obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
ece2d90e 2872These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
b044cda1 2873@code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
ece2d90e 2874@code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
b044cda1 2875@code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
ece2d90e 2876@code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
bb10df36 2877[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2878
2879@kindex --exclude-symbols
1d0a3c9c 2880@item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
252b5132
RH
2881Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
2882exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
bb10df36 2883[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2884
2927aaca
NC
2885@kindex --exclude-all-symbols
2886@item --exclude-all-symbols
2887Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
2888[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2889
252b5132
RH
2890@kindex --file-alignment
2891@item --file-alignment
2892Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
2893file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
2894512.
bb10df36 2895[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2896
2897@cindex heap size
2898@kindex --heap
2899@item --heap @var{reserve}
2900@itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 2901Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 2902to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 2903committed.
bb10df36 2904[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2905
2906@cindex image base
2907@kindex --image-base
2908@item --image-base @var{value}
2909Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
2910the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
2911is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
2912your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
2913other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
2914for dlls.
bb10df36 2915[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2916
2917@kindex --kill-at
2918@item --kill-at
2919If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
2920symbols before they are exported.
bb10df36 2921[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2922
26d2d8a2
BF
2923@kindex --large-address-aware
2924@item --large-address-aware
b45619c0 2925If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
26d2d8a2 2926header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
b45619c0 2927greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
26d2d8a2
BF
2928or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
2929section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
2930[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
2931
f69a2f97
NC
2932@kindex --disable-large-address-aware
2933@item --disable-large-address-aware
2934Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
2935This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
2936driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
2937addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
2938[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
2939
252b5132
RH
2940@kindex --major-image-version
2941@item --major-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2942Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
bb10df36 2943[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2944
2945@kindex --major-os-version
2946@item --major-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2947Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 2948[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2949
2950@kindex --major-subsystem-version
2951@item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2952Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 2953[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2954
2955@kindex --minor-image-version
2956@item --minor-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2957Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 2958[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2959
2960@kindex --minor-os-version
2961@item --minor-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2962Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 2963[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2964
2965@kindex --minor-subsystem-version
2966@item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2967Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 2968[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2969
2970@cindex DEF files, creating
2971@cindex DLLs, creating
2972@kindex --output-def
2973@item --output-def @var{file}
2974The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
2975file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
2976(which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
2977library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
2978automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
bb10df36 2979[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2980
b044cda1 2981@cindex DLLs, creating
b044cda1
CW
2982@kindex --enable-auto-image-base
2983@item --enable-auto-image-base
d0e6d77b
CF
2984@itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
2985Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
2986@var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
2987By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
2988for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
2989execution are avoided.
bb10df36 2990[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
2991
2992@kindex --disable-auto-image-base
2993@item --disable-auto-image-base
2994Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
2995user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
2996default.
bb10df36 2997[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
2998
2999@cindex DLLs, linking to
3000@kindex --dll-search-prefix
3001@item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
489d0400 3002When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
ece2d90e 3003search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
560e09e9 3004@code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
b044cda1
CW
3005between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
3006uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
ece2d90e 3007@code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
bb10df36 3008[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3009
3010@kindex --enable-auto-import
3011@item --enable-auto-import
ece2d90e 3012Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
317ff008
EB
3013DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
3014mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
3015[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3016
3017The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
3018feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
3019
3020Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
3021of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
3022PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
4d8907ac 3023
e2a83dd0
NC
3024Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
3025data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
3026placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
3027around a problem with consts that is described here:
3028http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
3029
4d8907ac
DS
3030Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
3031see this message:
0d888aac 3032
ece2d90e 3033"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
0d888aac
CW
3034documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
3035
ece2d90e
NC
3036This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
3037ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
c0065db7
RM
3038allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3039fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3040constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
2f8d8971
NC
3041multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3042this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
3043of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3044the warning, and exit.
3045
3046There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3047data type of the exported variable:
0d888aac 3048
2fa9fc65
NC
3049One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3050of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
560e09e9 3051this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
2fa9fc65 3052
c0065db7
RM
3053A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3054that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
3055there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
0d888aac
CW
3056a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
3057
3058@example
3059extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3060extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3061 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3062@end example
3063
3064or
3065
3066@example
3067extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3068extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3069 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3070@end example
3071
c0065db7 3072For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
2f8d8971 3073is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
0d888aac
CW
3074
3075@example
3076extern struct s extern_struct;
c0065db7 3077extern_struct.field -->
0d888aac
CW
3078 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3079@end example
3080
c406afaf
NC
3081or
3082
3083@example
3084extern long long extern_ll;
3085extern_ll -->
3086 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3087@end example
3088
2fa9fc65 3089A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
c0065db7 3090'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
11e7fd74 3091@code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
0d888aac 3092requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
c0065db7
RM
3093building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3094merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3095between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
0d888aac
CW
3096constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3097
3098Original:
3099@example
3100--foo.h
3101extern int arr[];
3102--foo.c
3103#include "foo.h"
3104void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3105 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3106@}
3107@end example
3108
3109Solution 1:
3110@example
3111--foo.h
3112extern int arr[];
3113--foo.c
3114#include "foo.h"
3115void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3116 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3117 volatile int *parr = arr;
3118 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3119@}
3120@end example
3121
3122Solution 2:
3123@example
3124--foo.h
3125/* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3126#if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3127 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3128#define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3129#else
3130#define FOO_IMPORT
3131#endif
3132extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3133--foo.c
3134#include "foo.h"
3135void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3136 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3137@}
3138@end example
3139
c0065db7 3140A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
0d888aac
CW
3141library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3142for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3143functions).
b044cda1
CW
3144
3145@kindex --disable-auto-import
3146@item --disable-auto-import
c0065db7 3147Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
b044cda1 3148@code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3149[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3150
2fa9fc65
NC
3151@kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3152@item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3153If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3154that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3155a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
c0065db7 3156environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
bb10df36 3157[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65
NC
3158
3159@kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3160@item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
317ff008 3161Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3162[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65 3163
b044cda1
CW
3164@kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3165@item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3166Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
bb10df36 3167[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3168
252b5132
RH
3169@kindex --section-alignment
3170@item --section-alignment
3171Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3172addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
bb10df36 3173[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3174
3175@cindex stack size
3176@kindex --stack
3177@item --stack @var{reserve}
3178@itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3179Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3180to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3181committed.
bb10df36 3182[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3183
3184@kindex --subsystem
3185@item --subsystem @var{which}
3186@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3187@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3188Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3189legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
33f362e1
NC
3190@code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3191the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3192@var{which}.
bb10df36 3193[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3194
2f563b51
DK
3195The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3196of the PE file header:
3197[These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3198
2d5c3743
NC
3199@kindex --high-entropy-va
3200@item --high-entropy-va
514b4e19 3201@itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
2d5c3743 3202Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
514b4e19
JD
3203(ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3204
dc9bd8c9
HD
3205This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3206@option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2d5c3743 3207
2f563b51
DK
3208@kindex --dynamicbase
3209@item --dynamicbase
514b4e19 3210@itemx --disable-dynamicbase
2f563b51
DK
3211The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3212randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
514b4e19
JD
3213Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3214can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
dc9bd8c9 3215This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2f563b51
DK
3216
3217@kindex --forceinteg
3218@item --forceinteg
514b4e19
JD
3219@itemx --disable-forceinteg
3220Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3221default.
2f563b51
DK
3222
3223@kindex --nxcompat
3224@item --nxcompat
514b4e19 3225@item --disable-nxcompat
2f563b51 3226The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
514b4e19
JD
3227This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3228targets. The option is enabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3229
3230@kindex --no-isolation
3231@item --no-isolation
514b4e19 3232@itemx --disable-no-isolation
2f563b51 3233Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
514b4e19 3234This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3235
3236@kindex --no-seh
3237@item --no-seh
514b4e19 3238@itemx --disable-no-seh
2f563b51 3239The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
514b4e19 3240this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3241
3242@kindex --no-bind
3243@item --no-bind
514b4e19
JD
3244@itemx --disable-no-bind
3245Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3246
3247@kindex --wdmdriver
3248@item --wdmdriver
514b4e19
JD
3249@itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3250The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3251by default.
9d5777a3 3252
2f563b51
DK
3253@kindex --tsaware
3254@item --tsaware
514b4e19
JD
3255@itemx --disable-tsaware
3256The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3257default.
2f563b51 3258
0cb112f7
CF
3259@kindex --insert-timestamp
3260@item --insert-timestamp
eeb14e5a
LZ
3261@itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3262Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3263as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3264other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
56e6cf80 3265will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
eeb14e5a
LZ
3266same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3267can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
56e6cf80 3268that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
eeb14e5a 3269identically.
dc9bd8c9
HD
3270
3271@kindex --enable-reloc-section
3272@item --enable-reloc-section
514b4e19 3273@itemx --disable-reloc-section
dc9bd8c9
HD
3274Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3275is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
514b4e19 3276This option is enabled by default.
252b5132
RH
3277@end table
3278
0285c67d
NC
3279@c man end
3280
ac145307
BS
3281@ifset C6X
3282@subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3283
3284@c man begin OPTIONS
3285
3286The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3287libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3288all executables use an index of 0.
3289
3290@table @gcctabopt
3291
3292@kindex --dsbt-size
3293@item --dsbt-size @var{size}
56e6cf80 3294This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
ac145307
BS
3295or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3296entries.
3297
3298@kindex --dsbt-index
3299@item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3300This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3301to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3302executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3303@code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3304
fbd9ad90
PB
3305@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3306The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3307exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3308
ac145307
BS
3309@end table
3310
3311@c man end
3312@end ifset
3313
b8891f8d
AJ
3314@ifset CSKY
3315@subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3316
3317@c man begin OPTIONS
3318
3319@table @gcctabopt
3320
3321@kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3322@item --branch-stub
3323This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3324sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3325usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3326can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3327the compiler or assembler.
3328
3329@kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3330@item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3331This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3332It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3333be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3334stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3335sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3336@samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3337linker should choose suitable defaults.
3338
3339@end table
3340
3341@c man end
3342@end ifset
3343
93fd0973
SC
3344@ifset M68HC11
3345@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3346
3347@c man begin OPTIONS
3348
3349The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3350memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3351
3352@table @gcctabopt
3353
3354@kindex --no-trampoline
3355@item --no-trampoline
3356This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3357is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3358instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3359
3360@kindex --bank-window
3361@item --bank-window @var{name}
3362This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3363the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3364The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3365paging and addresses within the memory window.
3366
3367@end table
3368
3369@c man end
3370@end ifset
3371
7fb9f789
NC
3372@ifset M68K
3373@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3374
3375@c man begin OPTIONS
3376
3377The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3378when linking for 68K targets.
3379
3380@table @gcctabopt
3381
3382@kindex --got
3383@item --got=@var{type}
3384This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3385@var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3386@samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3387Info entry for @file{ld}.
3388
3389@end table
3390
3391@c man end
3392@end ifset
3393
833794fc
MR
3394@ifset MIPS
3395@subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3396
3397@c man begin OPTIONS
3398
3399The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
8b10b0b3
MR
3400generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3401linking for MIPS targets.
833794fc
MR
3402
3403@table @gcctabopt
3404
3405@kindex --insn32
3406@item --insn32
3407@kindex --no-insn32
3408@itemx --no-insn32
3409These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3410generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3411or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
341232-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3413used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3414possible.
3415
8b10b0b3
MR
3416@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3417@item --ignore-branch-isa
3418@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3419@itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3420These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3421transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3422accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3423is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3424instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3425equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3426calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3427a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3428an error.
3429
3734320d
MF
3430@kindex --compact-branches
3431@item --compact-branches
3432@kindex --no-compact-branches
fa1477dc 3433@itemx --no-compact-branches
3734320d
MF
3434These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3435in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3436
833794fc
MR
3437@end table
3438
3439@c man end
3440@end ifset
3441
fa1477dc
SC
3442
3443@ifset PDP11
3444@subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3445
3446@c man begin OPTIONS
3447
3448For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3449produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3450for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3451targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3452defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3453here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3454
3455@table @gcctabopt
3456
3457@kindex -N
3458@item -N
3459@kindex --omagic
3460@itemx --omagic
3461
3462Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3463indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3464shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3465writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3466the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3467programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3468from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3469
3470@kindex -n
3471@item -n
3472@kindex --nmagic
3473@itemx --nmagic
3474
3475Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3476indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3477be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3478file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3479byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3480a @emph{pure executable} format.
3481
3482@kindex -z
3483@item -z
3484@kindex --imagic
3485@itemx --imagic
3486
3487Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3488indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3489data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3490instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3491larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3492to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3493shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3494option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3495and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3496this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3497executable} format.
3498
3499@kindex --no-omagic
3500@item --no-omagic
3501
3502Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3503
3504@end table
3505
3506@c man end
3507@end ifset
3508
252b5132
RH
3509@ifset UsesEnvVars
3510@node Environment
3511@section Environment Variables
3512
0285c67d
NC
3513@c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3514
560e09e9 3515You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
36f63dca
NC
3516@ifclear SingleFormat
3517@code{GNUTARGET},
3518@end ifclear
3519@code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
252b5132 3520
36f63dca 3521@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
3522@kindex GNUTARGET
3523@cindex default input format
3524@code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3525use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3526of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
ff5dcc92 3527@code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
252b5132
RH
3528of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3529attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3530this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3531there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3532object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3533BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3534in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
36f63dca 3535@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
3536
3537@kindex LDEMULATION
3538@cindex default emulation
3539@cindex emulation, default
3540@code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3541@samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3542behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3543available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3544the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3545variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3546linker was configured.
252b5132
RH
3547
3548@kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3549@cindex demangling, default
3550Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3551@code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3552default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3553a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3554may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3555options.
3556
0285c67d
NC
3557@c man end
3558@end ifset
3559
252b5132
RH
3560@node Scripts
3561@chapter Linker Scripts
3562
3563@cindex scripts
3564@cindex linker scripts
3565@cindex command files
3566Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3567written in the linker command language.
3568
3569The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3570the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3571the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3572more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3573direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3574described below.
3575
3576The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3577yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
a05a5b64
TP
3578linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3579to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
252b5132
RH
3580such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3581
3582You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3583line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3584default linker script.
3585
3586You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3587to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3588Linker Scripts}.
3589
3590@menu
3591* Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3592* Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3593* Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3594* Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3595* Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3596* SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3597* MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3598* PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3599* VERSION:: VERSION Command
3600* Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3601* Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3602@end menu
3603
3604@node Basic Script Concepts
3605@section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3606@cindex linker script concepts
3607We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3608describe the linker script language.
3609
3610The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3611file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3612@dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3613The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3614purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3615among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3616section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3617in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3618
3619Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3620also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
56dd11f0 3621contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
252b5132
RH
3622the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3623A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3624area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3625loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3626which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3627of debugging information.
3628
3629Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3630first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3631the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3632@dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3633section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3634same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3635is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3636(this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3637based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3638RAM address would be the VMA.
3639
3640You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3641program with the @samp{-h} option.
3642
3643Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3644@dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3645has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3646information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3647will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3648static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3649referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3650
3651You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3652program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3653option.
3654
3655@node Script Format
3656@section Linker Script Format
3657@cindex linker script format
3658Linker scripts are text files.
3659
3660You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3661either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3662symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3663generally ignored.
3664
3665Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3666If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3667otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3668double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3669file name.
3670
3671You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3672@samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3673to whitespace.
3674
3675@node Simple Example
3676@section Simple Linker Script Example
3677@cindex linker script example
3678@cindex example of linker script
3679Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3680
3681The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3682@samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3683memory layout of the output file.
3684
3685The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3686describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3687code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3688@samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3689Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3690your input files.
3691
3692For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
36930x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
3694linker script which will do that:
3695@smallexample
3696SECTIONS
3697@{
3698 . = 0x10000;
3699 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
3700 . = 0x8000000;
3701 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
3702 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
3703@}
3704@end smallexample
3705
3706You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
3707followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
3708descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
3709
252b5132
RH
3710The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
3711sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
3712counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
3713other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
3714current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
3715incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
3716@samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
3717
3718The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
3719required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
3720after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
3721which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
3722wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
3723means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
3724
3725Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
3726@samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
3727@samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
3728
3729The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
3730the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
3731at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
3732output section, the value of the location counter will be
3733@samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
3734effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
58434bc1 3735immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
252b5132
RH
3736
3737The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
3738alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
3739example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
3740sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
3741may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
3742sections.
3743
3744That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
3745
3746@node Simple Commands
3747@section Simple Linker Script Commands
3748@cindex linker script simple commands
3749In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
3750
3751@menu
3752* Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
3753* File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
3754@ifclear SingleFormat
3755* Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
3756@end ifclear
3757
4a93e180 3758* REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
252b5132
RH
3759* Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
3760@end menu
3761
3762@node Entry Point
36f63dca 3763@subsection Setting the Entry Point
252b5132
RH
3764@kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3765@cindex start of execution
3766@cindex first instruction
3767@cindex entry point
3768The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
3769point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
3770entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
3771@smallexample
3772ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3773@end smallexample
3774
3775There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
3776entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
3777stopping when one of them succeeds:
3778@itemize @bullet
a1ab1d2a 3779@item
252b5132 3780the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
a1ab1d2a 3781@item
252b5132 3782the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
a1ab1d2a 3783@item
a094d01f 3784the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
8a758655 3785targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3ab904c4 3786check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
a1ab1d2a 3787@item
252b5132 3788the address of the first byte of the @samp{.text} section, if present;
a1ab1d2a 3789@item
252b5132
RH
3790The address @code{0}.
3791@end itemize
3792
3793@node File Commands
36f63dca 3794@subsection Commands Dealing with Files
252b5132
RH
3795@cindex linker script file commands
3796Several linker script commands deal with files.
3797
3798@table @code
3799@item INCLUDE @var{filename}
3800@kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
3801@cindex including a linker script
3802Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
3803be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
ff5dcc92 3804with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
252b5132
RH
380510 levels deep.
3806
4006703d
NS
3807You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
3808@code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
3809
252b5132
RH
3810@item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3811@itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3812@kindex INPUT(@var{files})
3813@cindex input files in linker scripts
3814@cindex input object files in linker scripts
3815@cindex linker script input object files
3816The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
3817in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
3818
3819For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
3820a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
3821then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
3822
3823In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
3824script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
3825
e3f2db7f
AO
3826In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
3827with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
3828located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
16171946
FS
3829for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
3830@code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
3831filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
3832@samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
3833
3834If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
3835the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
3836found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
3837not found the linker will search through the archive library search
3838path.
252b5132 3839
ff5dcc92 3840If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
a05a5b64 3841name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
252b5132
RH
3842@samp{-l}.
3843
3844When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
3845files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
3846script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
3847
3848@item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3849@itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3850@kindex GROUP(@var{files})
3851@cindex grouping input files
3852The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
3853files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
3854new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
a05a5b64 3855in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
252b5132 3856
b717d30e
JJ
3857@item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3858@itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3859@kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
3860This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
3861commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
3862as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
3863with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
3864when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
3865@option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
3866and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
3867setting afterwards.
3868
252b5132
RH
3869@item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
3870@kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
b45619c0 3871@cindex output file name in linker script
252b5132
RH
3872The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
3873@code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
3874@samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
a05a5b64 3875Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
252b5132
RH
3876precedence.
3877
3878You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
3879output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
3880
3881@item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3882@kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3883@cindex library search path in linker script
3884@cindex archive search path in linker script
3885@cindex search path in linker script
3886The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
ff5dcc92 3887@command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
252b5132 3888@code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
a05a5b64 3889on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
252b5132 3890are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
a05a5b64 3891the command-line option are searched first.
252b5132
RH
3892
3893@item STARTUP(@var{filename})
3894@kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
3895@cindex first input file
3896The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
3897that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
3898though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
3899when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
3900first file.
3901@end table
3902
3903@ifclear SingleFormat
3904@node Format Commands
36f63dca 3905@subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
252b5132
RH
3906A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
3907
3908@table @code
3909@item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
3910@itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
3911@kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
3912@cindex output file format in linker script
3913The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
3914output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
024531e2 3915exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 3916(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
252b5132
RH
3917line option takes precedence.
3918
3919You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
a05a5b64 3920formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
252b5132
RH
3921This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
3922desired endianness.
3923
3924If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
3925will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
3926output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
3927used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
3928
3929For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
3930command:
3931@smallexample
3932OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
3933@end smallexample
3934This says that the default format for the output file is
a05a5b64 3935@samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
252b5132
RH
3936option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
3937format.
3938
3939@item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
3940@kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
3941@cindex input file format in linker script
3942The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
3943files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
3944This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 3945(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
252b5132
RH
3946is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
3947command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
3948@end table
3949@end ifclear
3950
4a93e180
NC
3951@node REGION_ALIAS
3952@subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
3953@kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
3954@cindex region alias
3955@cindex region names
3956
3957Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
3958@ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
3959
3960@smallexample
3961REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
3962@end smallexample
3963
3964The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
3965memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
3966to memory regions. An example follows.
3967
3968Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
3969memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
3970that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
3971non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
3972access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
3973read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
3974sections:
3975
3976@itemize @bullet
3977@item
3978@code{.text} program code;
3979@item
3980@code{.rodata} read-only data;
3981@item
3982@code{.data} read-write initialized data;
3983@item
3984@code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
3985@end itemize
3986
3987The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
3988part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
3989output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
3990systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
3991@code{C}:
3992@multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
3993@item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
9d5777a3 3994@item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4a93e180
NC
3995@item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
3996@item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
3997@item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
3998@end multitable
3999The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
4000loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
4001the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
4002the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
4003
4004The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
4005includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
4006memory layout:
4007@smallexample
4008INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
4009
4010SECTIONS
4011 @{
4012 .text :
4013 @{
4014 *(.text)
4015 @} > REGION_TEXT
4016 .rodata :
4017 @{
4018 *(.rodata)
4019 rodata_end = .;
4020 @} > REGION_RODATA
4021 .data : AT (rodata_end)
4022 @{
4023 data_start = .;
4024 *(.data)
4025 @} > REGION_DATA
4026 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
4027 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
4028 .bss :
4029 @{
4030 *(.bss)
4031 @} > REGION_BSS
4032 @}
4033@end smallexample
4034
4035Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
4036regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
4037variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
4038@table @code
4039@item A
4040Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4041@smallexample
4042MEMORY
4043 @{
4044 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4045 @}
4046
4047REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4048REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4049REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4050REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4051@end smallexample
4052@item B
4053Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
4054into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4055@code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4056@smallexample
4057MEMORY
4058 @{
4059 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4060 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4061 @}
4062
4063REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4064REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4065REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4066REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4067@end smallexample
4068@item C
4069Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4070@code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4071initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4072system start into the @code{RAM}.
4073@smallexample
4074MEMORY
4075 @{
4076 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4077 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4078 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4079 @}
4080
4081REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4082REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4083REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4084REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4085@end smallexample
4086@end table
4087
4088It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4089@code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4090necessary:
4091@smallexample
4092#include <string.h>
4093
4094extern char data_start [];
4095extern char data_size [];
4096extern char data_load_start [];
4097
4098void copy_data(void)
4099@{
4100 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4101 @{
4102 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4103 @}
4104@}
4105@end smallexample
4106
252b5132 4107@node Miscellaneous Commands
36f63dca 4108@subsection Other Linker Script Commands
252b5132
RH
4109There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4110
4111@table @code
4112@item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4113@kindex ASSERT
4114@cindex assertion in linker script
4115Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4116with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4117
fd1c4238
NC
4118Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4119take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4120inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4121for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4122symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4123
4124@smallexample
4125 .stack :
4126 @{
4127 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4128 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4129 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4130 @}
4131@end smallexample
4132
4133will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4134PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4135can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4136
4137@smallexample
4138 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4139 .stack :
4140 @{
4141 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4142 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4143 @}
4144@end smallexample
4145
4146will work.
4147
252b5132
RH
4148@item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4149@kindex EXTERN
4150@cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4151Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4152symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4153modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4154each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4155command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4156
4157@item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4158@kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4159@cindex common allocation in linker script
4160This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
ff5dcc92 4161to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
252b5132
RH
4162output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4163
4818e05f
AM
4164@item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4165@kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4166@cindex common allocation in linker script
4167This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4168command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4169to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4170
7bdf4127
AB
4171@item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4172@kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4173@cindex group allocation in linker script
4174@cindex section groups
4175@cindex COMDAT
4176This command has the same effect as the
4177@samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4178@command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4179and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4180specified (@samp{-r}).
4181
53d25da6
AM
4182@item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4183@kindex INSERT
4184@cindex insert user script into default script
4185This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4186augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4187inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4188@var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4189default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4190sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4191linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4192insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4193linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4194default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4195of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4196to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4197is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4198
4199@smallexample
4200SECTIONS
4201@{
4202 OVERLAY :
4203 @{
4204 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4205 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4206 @}
4207@}
4208INSERT AFTER .text;
4209@end smallexample
4210
252b5132
RH
4211@item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4212@kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4213@cindex cross references
ff5dcc92 4214This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
252b5132
RH
4215references among certain output sections.
4216
4217In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4218using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4219will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4220errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4221a function defined in the other section.
4222
4223The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
ff5dcc92 4224@command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
252b5132
RH
4225an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4226@code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4227names.
4228
cdf96953
MF
4229@item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4230@kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4231@cindex cross references
4232This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4233references to one section from a list of other sections.
4234
4235The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4236output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4237a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4238there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4239must never call back.
4240
4241The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4242The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4243If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4244the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4245status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4246names, not input section names.
4247
252b5132
RH
4248@ifclear SingleFormat
4249@item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4250@kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4251@cindex machine architecture
4252@cindex architecture
4253Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4254of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4255architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4256the @samp{-f} option.
4257@end ifclear
01554a74
AM
4258
4259@item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4260@kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4261This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4262@var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4263in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4264@xref{Expression Section}.
252b5132
RH
4265@end table
4266
4267@node Assignments
4268@section Assigning Values to Symbols
4269@cindex assignment in scripts
4270@cindex symbol definition, scripts
4271@cindex variables, defining
4272You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
73ae6183 4273the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
252b5132
RH
4274
4275@menu
4276* Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
eb8476a6 4277* HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
252b5132 4278* PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
7af8e998 4279* PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
73ae6183 4280* Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
252b5132
RH
4281@end menu
4282
4283@node Simple Assignments
4284@subsection Simple Assignments
4285
4286You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4287
4288@table @code
4289@item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4290@itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4291@itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4292@itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4293@itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4294@itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4295@itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4296@itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4297@itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4298@end table
4299
4300The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4301@var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4302defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4303
4304The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
b5666f2f 4305may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
252b5132
RH
4306
4307The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4308
4309Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4310
4311You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4312statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4313section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4314
4315The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4316expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4317
4318Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4319assignments may be used:
4320
4321@smallexample
4322floating_point = 0;
4323SECTIONS
4324@{
4325 .text :
4326 @{
4327 *(.text)
4328 _etext = .;
4329 @}
156e34dd 4330 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
252b5132
RH
4331 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4332@}
4333@end smallexample
4334@noindent
4335In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4336zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4337the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4338defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4339upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4340
eb8476a6
MR
4341@node HIDDEN
4342@subsection HIDDEN
4343@cindex HIDDEN
4344For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4345exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4346
4347Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4348@code{HIDDEN}:
4349
4350@smallexample
4351HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4352SECTIONS
4353@{
4354 .text :
4355 @{
4356 *(.text)
4357 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4358 @}
4359 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4360 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4361@}
4362@end smallexample
4363@noindent
4364In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4365
252b5132
RH
4366@node PROVIDE
4367@subsection PROVIDE
4368@cindex PROVIDE
4369In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4370only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4371the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4372@samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4373@samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4374@code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4375@samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4376@code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4377
4378Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4379@smallexample
4380SECTIONS
4381@{
4382 .text :
4383 @{
4384 *(.text)
4385 _etext = .;
4386 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4387 @}
4388@}
4389@end smallexample
4390
4391In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
4392underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition error. If, on
4393the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
4394underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4395If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4396linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4397
b0daac83
NC
4398Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4399defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4400that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4401when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4402@samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4403
7af8e998
L
4404@node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4405@subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4406@cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4407Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4408hidden and won't be exported.
4409
73ae6183
NC
4410@node Source Code Reference
4411@subsection Source Code Reference
4412
4413Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4414intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4415a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4416symbol that does not have a value.
4417
4418Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4419transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4420stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4421prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4422mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4423of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4424variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4425linker script variable might be referred to as:
4426
4427@smallexample
4428 extern int foo;
4429@end smallexample
4430
4431But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4432
4433@smallexample
4434 _foo = 1000;
4435@end smallexample
4436
4437In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4438transformation has taken place.
4439
4440When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4441things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4442in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4443second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4444table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4445contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4446value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4447
4448@smallexample
4449 int foo = 1000;
4450@end smallexample
4451
10bf6894 4452creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
73ae6183
NC
4453holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4454number 1000 is initially stored.
4455
4456When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4457first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4458memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4459So:
4460
4461@smallexample
4462 foo = 1;
4463@end smallexample
4464
4465looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4466associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4467address. Whereas:
4468
4469@smallexample
4470 int * a = & foo;
4471@end smallexample
4472
10bf6894 4473looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
73ae6183
NC
4474and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4475the variable @samp{a}.
4476
4477Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4478the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4479an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4480
4481@smallexample
4482 foo = 1000;
4483@end smallexample
4484
4485creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4486the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4487address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4488linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4489access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4490
4491Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4492you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4493use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4494section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4495linker script contains these declarations:
4496
4497@smallexample
4498@group
4499 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
a5e406b5 4500 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
73ae6183
NC
4501 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4502@end group
4503@end smallexample
4504
4505Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4506
4507@smallexample
4508@group
4509 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
c0065db7 4510
73ae6183
NC
4511 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4512@end group
4513@end smallexample
4514
4515Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
5707d2ad
NC
4516Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4517arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4518
4519@smallexample
4520@group
4521 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4522
4523 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4524@end group
4525@end smallexample
4526
4527Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4528operators.
73ae6183 4529
252b5132 4530@node SECTIONS
36f63dca 4531@section SECTIONS Command
252b5132
RH
4532@kindex SECTIONS
4533The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4534into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4535
4536The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4537@smallexample
4538SECTIONS
4539@{
4540 @var{sections-command}
4541 @var{sections-command}
4542 @dots{}
4543@}
4544@end smallexample
4545
4546Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4547
4548@itemize @bullet
4549@item
4550an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4551@item
4552a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4553@item
4554an output section description
4555@item
4556an overlay description
4557@end itemize
4558
4559The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4560@code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4561those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4562understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4563the layout of the output file.
4564
4565Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4566below.
4567
4568If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4569linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4570section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4571input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4572example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4573in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4574
4575@menu
4576* Output Section Description:: Output section description
4577* Output Section Name:: Output section name
4578* Output Section Address:: Output section address
4579* Input Section:: Input section description
4580* Output Section Data:: Output section data
4581* Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4582* Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4583* Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4584* Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4585@end menu
4586
4587@node Output Section Description
36f63dca 4588@subsection Output Section Description
252b5132
RH
4589The full description of an output section looks like this:
4590@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 4591@group
7e7d5768 4592@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 4593 [AT(@var{lma})]
1eec346e 4594 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
4595 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4596 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
4597 @{
4598 @var{output-section-command}
4599 @var{output-section-command}
4600 @dots{}
abc9061b 4601 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
252b5132
RH
4602@end group
4603@end smallexample
4604
4605Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4606
4607The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4608name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
abc9061b
CC
4609The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4610the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
252b5132
RH
4611The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4612
4613Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4614
4615@itemize @bullet
4616@item
4617a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4618@item
4619an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4620@item
4621data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4622@item
4623a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4624@end itemize
4625
4626@node Output Section Name
36f63dca 4627@subsection Output Section Name
252b5132
RH
4628@cindex name, section
4629@cindex section name
4630The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4631meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4632support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4633must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4634example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4635output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4636names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4637quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4638characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4639commas must be quoted.
4640
4641The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4642Discarding}.
4643
4644@node Output Section Address
2a16d82a 4645@subsection Output Section Address
252b5132
RH
4646@cindex address, section
4647@cindex section address
4648The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
ea5cae92
NC
4649address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4650is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4651
4652If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4653section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4654to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4655alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4656contained within the output section.
4657
4658The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4659
4660@itemize @bullet
4661@item
4662If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4663is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4664in that region.
4665
4666@item
4667If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4668regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4669section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4670be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4671
4672@item
4673If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4674the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4675counter.
4676@end itemize
4677
4678@noindent
4679For example:
4680
252b5132
RH
4681@smallexample
4682.text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4683@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4684
252b5132
RH
4685@noindent
4686and
ea5cae92 4687
252b5132
RH
4688@smallexample
4689.text : @{ *(.text) @}
4690@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4691
252b5132
RH
4692@noindent
4693are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
4694@samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
4695counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
ea5cae92
NC
4696counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
4697input sections.
252b5132
RH
4698
4699The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
4700For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
4701so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
4702do something like this:
4703@smallexample
4704.text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
4705@end smallexample
4706@noindent
4707This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
4708aligned upward to the specified value.
4709
4710Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
6ce340f1
NC
4711location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
4712sections are ignored).
252b5132
RH
4713
4714@node Input Section
36f63dca 4715@subsection Input Section Description
252b5132
RH
4716@cindex input sections
4717@cindex mapping input sections to output sections
4718The most common output section command is an input section description.
4719
4720The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
4721You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
4722in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
4723map the input files into your memory layout.
4724
4725@menu
4726* Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
4727* Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
4728* Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
4729* Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
4730* Input Section Example:: Input section example
4731@end menu
4732
4733@node Input Section Basics
36f63dca 4734@subsubsection Input Section Basics
252b5132
RH
4735@cindex input section basics
4736An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
4737by a list of section names in parentheses.
4738
4739The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
4740describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
4741
4742The most common input section description is to include all input
4743sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
4744include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
4745@smallexample
4746*(.text)
4747@end smallexample
4748@noindent
18625d54 4749Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
8f1732fc 4750@cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
18625d54
CM
4751of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
4752match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
4753example:
252b5132 4754@smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4755EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
4756@end smallexample
4757@noindent
4758will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
4759and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
4760placed inside the section list, for example:
4761@smallexample
b4346c09 4762*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
252b5132 4763@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4764@noindent
4765The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
4766two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
4767more than one section, as described below.
252b5132
RH
4768
4769There are two ways to include more than one section:
4770@smallexample
4771*(.text .rdata)
4772*(.text) *(.rdata)
4773@end smallexample
4774@noindent
4775The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
4776@samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
b6bf44ba
AM
4777first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
4778they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
252b5132
RH
4779@samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
4780@samp{.rdata} input sections.
4781
8f1732fc
AB
4782When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
4783is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
4784immediately following section, for example:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4785@smallexample
4786*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
4787@end smallexample
4788@noindent
4789will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
4790@file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
4791from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
4792exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
8f1732fc 4793could be modified to:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4794@smallexample
4795*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
4796@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4797@noindent
4798Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
4799before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
4800all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
4801@smallexample
4802EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
4803@end smallexample
a5bf7d4f 4804
252b5132
RH
4805You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
4806You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
4807needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
4808@smallexample
4809data.o(.data)
4810@end smallexample
4811
ae17ab41
CM
4812To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
4813of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
4814
4815Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
4816
4817@smallexample
4818@group
4819SECTIONS @{
4820 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
4821 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
4822@}
4823@end group
4824@end smallexample
4825
4826In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
4827input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
4828@code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
4829@samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
4830whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
4831
967928e9
AM
4832You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
4833matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
4834with no whitespace around the colon.
4835
4836@table @samp
4837@item archive:file
4838matches file within archive
4839@item archive:
4840matches the whole archive
4841@item :file
4842matches file but not one in an archive
4843@end table
4844
4845Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
4846wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
4847single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
4848@samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
4849within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
4850also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
4851other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
4852from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
4853command.
4854
252b5132
RH
4855If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
4856the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
4857commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
4858@smallexample
4859data.o
4860@end smallexample
4861
967928e9
AM
4862When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
4863and does not contain any wild card
252b5132
RH
4864characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
4865name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
4866did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
4867though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
4868@code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
4869the archive search path.
4870
4871@node Input Section Wildcards
36f63dca 4872@subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
252b5132
RH
4873@cindex input section wildcards
4874@cindex wildcard file name patterns
4875@cindex file name wildcard patterns
4876@cindex section name wildcard patterns
4877In an input section description, either the file name or the section
4878name or both may be wildcard patterns.
4879
4880The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
4881pattern for the file name.
4882
4883The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
4884
4885@table @samp
4886@item *
4887matches any number of characters
4888@item ?
4889matches any single character
4890@item [@var{chars}]
4891matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
4892character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
4893@samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
4894@item \
4895quotes the following character
4896@end table
4897
4898When a file name is matched with a wildcard, the wildcard characters
4899will not match a @samp{/} character (used to separate directory names on
4900Unix). A pattern consisting of a single @samp{*} character is an
4901exception; it will always match any file name, whether it contains a
4902@samp{/} or not. In a section name, the wildcard characters will match
4903a @samp{/} character.
4904
4905File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
4906specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
4907does not search directories to expand wildcards.
4908
4909If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
4910appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
4911will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
4912sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
4913@file{data.o} rule will not be used:
4914@smallexample
4915.data : @{ *(.data) @}
4916.data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
4917@end smallexample
4918
bcaa7b3e 4919@cindex SORT_BY_NAME
252b5132
RH
4920Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
4921in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
bcaa7b3e
L
4922this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
4923pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
4924@code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
252b5132
RH
4925into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
4926
bcaa7b3e 4927@cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
9a24a276
AM
4928@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4929@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
4930alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
4931alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
4932needed.
bcaa7b3e 4933
02ecc8e9 4934@cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
9a24a276
AM
4935@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4936@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
4937numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
4938section name before placing them in the output file. In
4939@code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
4940the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
4941@code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
02ecc8e9 4942
bcaa7b3e
L
4943@cindex SORT
4944@code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4945
4946When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
4947can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
4948
4949@enumerate
4950@item
4951@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 4952It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
bcaa7b3e
L
4953sections have the same name.
4954@item
4955@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 4956It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
bcaa7b3e
L
4957sections have the same alignment.
4958@item
c0065db7 4959@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
bcaa7b3e
L
4960treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
4961@item
4962@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
4963is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
4964@item
4965All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
4966@end enumerate
4967
a05a5b64 4968When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
bcaa7b3e 4969section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
a05a5b64 4970takes precedence over the command-line option.
bcaa7b3e
L
4971
4972If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
a05a5b64 4973command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
bcaa7b3e
L
4974treated as nested sorting command.
4975
4976@enumerate
4977@item
4978@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
4979@option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
4980@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
4981@item
4982@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
4983@option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
4984@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
4985@end enumerate
4986
4987If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
a05a5b64 4988command-line option will be ignored.
bcaa7b3e 4989
eda680f8 4990@cindex SORT_NONE
a05a5b64 4991@code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
eda680f8
L
4992section sorting option.
4993
252b5132
RH
4994If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
4995@samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
4996precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
4997
4998This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
4999files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
5000sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
5001The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
5002with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
5003linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
5004@smallexample
5005@group
5006SECTIONS @{
5007 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5008 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
5009 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5010 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
5011@}
5012@end group
5013@end smallexample
5014
5015@node Input Section Common
36f63dca 5016@subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
252b5132
RH
5017@cindex common symbol placement
5018@cindex uninitialized data placement
5019A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
5020file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
5021linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
5022named @samp{COMMON}.
5023
5024You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
5025other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
5026particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
5027input files are placed in another section.
5028
5029In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
5030@samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
5031@smallexample
5032.bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
5033@end smallexample
5034
5035@cindex scommon section
5036@cindex small common symbols
5037Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
5038example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5039symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
5040different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
5041the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5042symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
5043to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5044locations.
5045
5046@cindex [COMMON]
5047You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
5048notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
5049@samp{*(COMMON)}.
5050
5051@node Input Section Keep
36f63dca 5052@subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
252b5132
RH
5053@cindex KEEP
5054@cindex garbage collection
5055When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
a1ab1d2a 5056it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
252b5132
RH
5057This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5058with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
bcaa7b3e 5059@code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
252b5132
RH
5060
5061@node Input Section Example
36f63dca 5062@subsubsection Input Section Example
252b5132
RH
5063The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5064to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5065start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5066@samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5067follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5068@samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5069@samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5070All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5071files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5072
5073@smallexample
5074@group
5075SECTIONS @{
5076 outputa 0x10000 :
5077 @{
5078 all.o
5079 foo.o (.input1)
5080 @}
36f63dca
NC
5081@end group
5082@group
252b5132
RH
5083 outputb :
5084 @{
5085 foo.o (.input2)
5086 foo1.o (.input1)
5087 @}
36f63dca
NC
5088@end group
5089@group
252b5132
RH
5090 outputc :
5091 @{
5092 *(.input1)
5093 *(.input2)
5094 @}
5095@}
5096@end group
a1ab1d2a 5097@end smallexample
252b5132 5098
cbd0eecf
L
5099If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5100and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5101automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5102__stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5103indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5104respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5105C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
5106
252b5132 5107@node Output Section Data
36f63dca 5108@subsection Output Section Data
252b5132
RH
5109@cindex data
5110@cindex section data
5111@cindex output section data
5112@kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5113@kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5114@kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5115@kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5116@kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5117You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5118@code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5119an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5120parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5121value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5122counter.
5123
5124The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5125store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5126bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5127stored.
5128
5129For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5130of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5131@smallexample
5132BYTE(1)
5133LONG(addr)
5134@end smallexample
5135
5136When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5137same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5138target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5139@code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5140@code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5141
5142If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5143which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5144When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5145true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5146endianness of the first input object file.
5147
36f63dca 5148Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
2b5fc1f5
NC
5149between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5150@smallexample
5151SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5152@end smallexample
5153whereas this will work:
5154@smallexample
5155SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5156@end smallexample
5157
252b5132
RH
5158@kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5159@cindex holes, filling
5160@cindex unspecified memory
5161You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5162current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5163otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5164gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
a139d329 5165with the value of the expression, repeated as
252b5132
RH
5166necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5167point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5168than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5169different parts of an output section.
5170
5171This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
563e308f 5172value @samp{0x90}:
252b5132 5173@smallexample
563e308f 5174FILL(0x90909090)
252b5132
RH
5175@end smallexample
5176
5177The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
9673c93c 5178section attribute, but it only affects the
252b5132
RH
5179part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5180entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
9673c93c 5181precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
a139d329 5182expression.
252b5132
RH
5183
5184@node Output Section Keywords
36f63dca 5185@subsection Output Section Keywords
252b5132
RH
5186There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5187commands.
5188
5189@table @code
5190@kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5191@cindex input filename symbols
5192@cindex filename symbols
5193@item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5194The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5195The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5196file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5197the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5198
5199This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5200normally used for any other object file format.
5201
5202@kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5203@cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5204@cindex constructors, arranging in link
5205@item CONSTRUCTORS
5206When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5207unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5208destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5209arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5210automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5211For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5212linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5213@code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5214ignored for other object file formats.
5215
5216The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
7e69709c
AM
5217constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5218Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5219the start and end of the global destructors. The
252b5132
RH
5220first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5221of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5222compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5223formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5224@code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5225the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5226destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5227@code{exit}.
5228
5229For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5230arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5231addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5232and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5233linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5234runtime code expects to see.
5235
5236@smallexample
5237 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5238 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5239 *(.ctors)
5240 LONG(0)
5241 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5242 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5243 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5244 *(.dtors)
5245 LONG(0)
5246 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5247@end smallexample
5248
5249If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5250which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5251are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5252are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
bcaa7b3e
L
5253command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5254@code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5255@samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
252b5132
RH
5256@samp{*(.dtors)}.
5257
5258Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5259and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5260need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5261scripts.
5262
5263@end table
5264
5265@node Output Section Discarding
36f63dca 5266@subsection Output Section Discarding
252b5132
RH
5267@cindex discarding sections
5268@cindex sections, discarding
5269@cindex removing sections
2edab91c
AM
5270The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5271This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5272may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
252b5132 5273@smallexample
49c13adb 5274.foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
252b5132
RH
5275@end smallexample
5276@noindent
5277will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
74541ad4
AM
5278@samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5279sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
2edab91c
AM
5280space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5281too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5282space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5283@samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5284@samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5285This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
74541ad4 5286
a0976ea4 5287The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
74541ad4
AM
5288on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5289symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
a0976ea4
AM
5290the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5291section is discarded.
252b5132
RH
5292
5293@cindex /DISCARD/
5294The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5295input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5296section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5297
99fabbc9
JL
5298This can be used to discard input sections marked with the ELF flag
5299@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN}, which would otherwise have been saved from linker
5300garbage collection.
5301
a2e098c3
NC
5302Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5303discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5304members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5305Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5306
252b5132 5307@node Output Section Attributes
36f63dca 5308@subsection Output Section Attributes
252b5132
RH
5309@cindex output section attributes
5310We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5311like this:
0c71d759 5312
252b5132 5313@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 5314@group
7e7d5768 5315@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 5316 [AT(@var{lma})]
3bbec4bd 5317 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
5318 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5319 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
5320 @{
5321 @var{output-section-command}
5322 @var{output-section-command}
5323 @dots{}
562d3460 5324 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
252b5132
RH
5325@end group
5326@end smallexample
0c71d759 5327
252b5132
RH
5328We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5329@var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5330remaining section attributes.
5331
a1ab1d2a 5332@menu
252b5132
RH
5333* Output Section Type:: Output section type
5334* Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
bbf115d3 5335* Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
7e7d5768 5336* Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
0c71d759 5337* Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
252b5132
RH
5338* Output Section Region:: Output section region
5339* Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5340* Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5341@end menu
5342
5343@node Output Section Type
36f63dca 5344@subsubsection Output Section Type
252b5132
RH
5345Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5346parentheses. The following types are defined:
5347
5348@table @code
5349@item NOLOAD
5350The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5351loaded into memory when the program is run.
5352@item DSECT
5353@itemx COPY
5354@itemx INFO
5355@itemx OVERLAY
5356These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5357rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5358marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5359section when the program is run.
5360@end table
5361
5362@kindex NOLOAD
5363@cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5364@cindex loading, preventing
5365The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5366the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5367the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5368@samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
2e76e85a 5369need to be loaded when the program is run.
252b5132
RH
5370@smallexample
5371@group
5372SECTIONS @{
5373 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5374 @dots{}
5375@}
5376@end group
5377@end smallexample
5378
5379@node Output Section LMA
36f63dca 5380@subsubsection Output Section LMA
562d3460 5381@kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
252b5132
RH
5382@kindex AT(@var{lma})
5383@cindex load address
5384@cindex section load address
5385Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
ea5cae92
NC
5386@ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5387@pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5388specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5389address is optional.
6bdafbeb 5390
ea5cae92
NC
5391The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5392specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5393takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5394load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5395region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
dc0b6aa0
AM
5396
5397If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
ea5cae92
NC
5398section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5399load address:
5400
5401@itemize @bullet
5402@item
5403If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5404the LMA address as well.
5405
5406@item
5407If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5408
5409@item
5410Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5411with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5412section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5413VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5414the last section in the located region.
5415
5416@item
5417If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5418that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5419
5420@item
5421If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5422section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5423@end itemize
252b5132
RH
5424
5425@cindex ROM initialized data
5426@cindex initialized data in ROM
5427This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5428example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5429called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5430@samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5431even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5432uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5433defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5434counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5435
5436@smallexample
5437@group
5438SECTIONS
5439 @{
5440 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
a1ab1d2a 5441 .mdata 0x2000 :
252b5132
RH
5442 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5443 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5444 .bss 0x3000 :
5445 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5446@}
5447@end group
5448@end smallexample
5449
5450The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5451this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5452the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5453how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5454script.
5455
5456@smallexample
5457@group
5458extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5459char *src = &_etext;
5460char *dst = &_data;
5461
ea5cae92
NC
5462/* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5463while (dst < &_edata)
252b5132 5464 *dst++ = *src++;
252b5132 5465
ea5cae92 5466/* Zero bss. */
252b5132
RH
5467for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5468 *dst = 0;
5469@end group
5470@end smallexample
5471
bbf115d3
L
5472@node Forced Output Alignment
5473@subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5474@kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5475@cindex forcing output section alignment
5476@cindex output section alignment
1eec346e 5477You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
13075d04
SH
5478alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5479intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
bbf115d3 5480
7e7d5768
AM
5481@node Forced Input Alignment
5482@subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5483@kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5484@cindex forcing input section alignment
5485@cindex input section alignment
5486You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5487SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5488sections, whether larger or smaller.
5489
0c71d759
NC
5490@node Output Section Constraint
5491@subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5492@kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5493@kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5494@cindex constraints on output sections
5495You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5496of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5497read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5498@code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5499
252b5132 5500@node Output Section Region
36f63dca 5501@subsubsection Output Section Region
252b5132
RH
5502@kindex >@var{region}
5503@cindex section, assigning to memory region
5504@cindex memory regions and sections
5505You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5506using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5507
5508Here is a simple example:
5509@smallexample
5510@group
5511MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5512SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5513@end group
5514@end smallexample
5515
5516@node Output Section Phdr
36f63dca 5517@subsubsection Output Section Phdr
252b5132
RH
5518@kindex :@var{phdr}
5519@cindex section, assigning to program header
5520@cindex program headers and sections
5521You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5522using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5523one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5524assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5525@code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5526linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5527
5528Here is a simple example:
5529@smallexample
5530@group
5531PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5532SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5533@end group
5534@end smallexample
5535
5536@node Output Section Fill
36f63dca 5537@subsubsection Output Section Fill
252b5132
RH
5538@kindex =@var{fillexp}
5539@cindex section fill pattern
5540@cindex fill pattern, entire section
5541You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5542@samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5543(@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5544within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
a139d329
AM
5545alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5546necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
9673c93c 5547of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
a139d329
AM
5548an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5549fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
9673c93c 5550other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
a139d329
AM
5551pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5552expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
252b5132
RH
5553
5554You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
9673c93c 5555output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
252b5132
RH
5556
5557Here is a simple example:
5558@smallexample
5559@group
563e308f 5560SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
252b5132
RH
5561@end group
5562@end smallexample
5563
5564@node Overlay Description
36f63dca 5565@subsection Overlay Description
252b5132
RH
5566@kindex OVERLAY
5567@cindex overlays
5568An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5569are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5570the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5571copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5572required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5573can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5574than another.
5575
5576Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5577@code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5578output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5579command is as follows:
5580@smallexample
5581@group
5582OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5583 @{
5584 @var{secname1}
5585 @{
5586 @var{output-section-command}
5587 @var{output-section-command}
5588 @dots{}
5589 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5590 @var{secname2}
5591 @{
5592 @var{output-section-command}
5593 @var{output-section-command}
5594 @dots{}
5595 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5596 @dots{}
abc9061b 5597 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
252b5132
RH
5598@end group
5599@end smallexample
5600
5601Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5602section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5603section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
11e7fd74 5604those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
252b5132
RH
5605except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5606sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5607
abc9061b
CC
5608The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5609the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5610
252b5132
RH
5611The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5612addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5613memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5614whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5615and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5616and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5617
56dd11f0
NC
5618If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5619references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5620the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5621sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5622@xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
252b5132
RH
5623
5624For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
34711ca3 5625provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
252b5132
RH
5626defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5627@code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5628the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5629within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5630symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5631
5632At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
5633the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
5634
5635Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
5636@code{SECTIONS} construct.
5637@smallexample
5638@group
5639 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
5640 @{
5641 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5642 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5643 @}
5644@end group
5645@end smallexample
5646@noindent
5647This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
5648address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
5649@samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
34711ca3 5650following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
252b5132
RH
5651@code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
5652@code{__load_stop_text1}.
5653
5654C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
5655like the following.
5656
5657@smallexample
5658@group
5659 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
5660 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
5661 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
5662@end group
5663@end smallexample
5664
5665Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
5666everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
5667example could have been written identically as follows.
5668
5669@smallexample
5670@group
5671 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5672 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
5673 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
252b5132 5674 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5675 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
5676 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
252b5132
RH
5677 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
5678@end group
5679@end smallexample
5680
5681@node MEMORY
36f63dca 5682@section MEMORY Command
252b5132
RH
5683@kindex MEMORY
5684@cindex memory regions
5685@cindex regions of memory
5686@cindex allocating memory
5687@cindex discontinuous memory
5688The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
5689memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
5690
5691The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
5692memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
5693may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
5694can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
5695set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
5696regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
5697around to fit into the available regions.
5698
127fcdff
AB
5699A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
5700however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
5701specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
5702@code{MEMORY} is:
252b5132
RH
5703@smallexample
5704@group
a1ab1d2a 5705MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5706 @{
5707 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
5708 @dots{}
5709 @}
5710@end group
5711@end smallexample
5712
5713The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
5714region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
5715Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5716with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
4a93e180
NC
5717must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
5718add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
9d5777a3 5719command.
252b5132
RH
5720
5721@cindex memory region attributes
5722The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
5723whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
5724not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
5725@ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
5726section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
5727the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
5728them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
5729
5730The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
5731@table @samp
5732@item R
5733Read-only section
5734@item W
5735Read/write section
5736@item X
5737Executable section
5738@item A
5739Allocatable section
5740@item I
5741Initialized section
5742@item L
5743Same as @samp{I}
5744@item !
c09e9a8c 5745Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
252b5132
RH
5746@end table
5747
81c688d5 5748If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
252b5132 5749@samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
81c688d5
NC
5750attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
5751unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
5752not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
5753string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
5754or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
5755the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
252b5132
RH
5756
5757@kindex ORIGIN =
5758@kindex o =
5759@kindex org =
9cd6d51a
NC
5760The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
5761the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
5762cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
5763abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
5764@code{ORG}).
252b5132
RH
5765
5766@kindex LENGTH =
5767@kindex len =
5768@kindex l =
5769The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
5770region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
9cd6d51a
NC
5771be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
5772@code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
252b5132
RH
5773
5774In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
5775available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
5776and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
5777linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
5778is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
5779or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
5780explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
5781region.
5782
5783@smallexample
5784@group
a1ab1d2a 5785MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5786 @{
5787 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
5788 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
5789 @}
5790@end group
5791@end smallexample
5792
5793Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
5794specific output sections into that memory region by using the
5795@samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
5796a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
5797output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
5798was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
5799the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
5800output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
5801region, the linker will issue an error message.
5802
3ec57632 5803It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
c0065db7 5804expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
3ec57632
NC
5805@code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
5806
5807@smallexample
5808@group
c0065db7 5809 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
3ec57632
NC
5810@end group
5811@end smallexample
5812
252b5132
RH
5813@node PHDRS
5814@section PHDRS Command
5815@kindex PHDRS
5816@cindex program headers
5817@cindex ELF program headers
5818@cindex program segments
5819@cindex segments, ELF
5820The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
5821@dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
5822loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
5823program with the @samp{-p} option.
5824
5825When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
5826reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
5827program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
5828This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
5829interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
5830
5831The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
5832in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
5833precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
5834the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
5835not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
5836
5837The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
5838generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
5839ignore @code{PHDRS}.
5840
5841This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
5842@code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
5843
5844@smallexample
5845@group
5846PHDRS
5847@{
5848 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
5849 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
5850@}
5851@end group
5852@end smallexample
5853
5854The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
5855of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
5856header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5857with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
5c1a3f0f
NS
5858must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
5859is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
252b5132
RH
5860
5861Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
5862system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
5863specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
5864sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
5865attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
5866Section Phdr}.
5867
5868It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
5869merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
5870repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
5871contain the section.
5872
5873If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
5874then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
5875not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
5876convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
5877placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
5878default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
5879segment at all.
5880
5881@kindex FILEHDR
5882@kindex PHDRS
5c1a3f0f 5883You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
252b5132
RH
5884the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
5885The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
5886file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
5c1a3f0f 5887include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
4100cea3
AM
5888segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
5889these keywords.
252b5132
RH
5890
5891The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
5892value of the keyword.
5893
5894@table @asis
5895@item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
5896Indicates an unused program header.
5897
5898@item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
5899Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
5900the file.
5901
5902@item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
5903Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
5904
5905@item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
5906Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
5907found.
5908
5909@item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
5910Indicates a segment holding note information.
5911
5912@item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
5913A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
5914ABI.
5915
5916@item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
5917Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
5918
1a9ccd70
NC
5919@item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
5920Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
5921
252b5132
RH
5922@item @var{expression}
5923An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
5924be used for types not defined above.
5925@end table
5926
5927You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
5928in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
5929@code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
5930Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
5931output section attribute.
5932
5933The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
5934which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
5935explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
5936an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
5937header.
5938
5939Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
5940headers used on a native ELF system.
5941
5942@example
5943@group
5944PHDRS
5945@{
5946 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
5947 interp PT_INTERP ;
5948 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
5949 data PT_LOAD ;
5950 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
5951@}
5952
5953SECTIONS
5954@{
5955 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
5956 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
5957 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
5958 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
5959 @dots{}
5960 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
5961 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
5962 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
5963 @dots{}
5964@}
5965@end group
5966@end example
5967
5968@node VERSION
5969@section VERSION Command
5970@kindex VERSION @{script text@}
5971@cindex symbol versions
5972@cindex version script
5973@cindex versions of symbols
5974The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
5975only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
5976symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
5977a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
5978shared library.
5979
5980You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
5981you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
5982also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
5983
5984The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
5985@smallexample
5986VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
5987@end smallexample
5988
5989The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
5990Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
5991version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
5992version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
5993version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
5994scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
5995library.
5996
5997The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
5998examples.
5999
6000@smallexample
6001VERS_1.1 @{
6002 global:
6003 foo1;
6004 local:
a1ab1d2a
UD
6005 old*;
6006 original*;
6007 new*;
252b5132
RH
6008@};
6009
6010VERS_1.2 @{
6011 foo2;
6012@} VERS_1.1;
6013
6014VERS_2.0 @{
6015 bar1; bar2;
c0065db7 6016 extern "C++" @{
86043bbb 6017 ns::*;
bb1515f2
MF
6018 "f(int, double)";
6019 @};
252b5132
RH
6020@} VERS_1.2;
6021@end smallexample
6022
6023This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
6024version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
6025The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
6026a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
313e35ee
AM
6027of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
6028symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
6029is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
6030in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
86043bbb
MM
6031However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
6032name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
252b5132
RH
6033
6034Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
6035depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
6036to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
6037
6038Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
6039depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
6040and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
6041
6042When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6043specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6044unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
a981ed6f 6045unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
ae5a3597
AM
6046somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6047wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
6048wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6049set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
6050ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
252b5132
RH
6051
6052The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6053they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
6054could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6055However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6056
0f6bf451 6057Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6b9b879a
JJ
6058in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6059symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6060won't.
6061
6062@smallexample
7c9c73be 6063@{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
9d201f2f 6064@end smallexample
6b9b879a 6065
252b5132
RH
6066When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6067symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6068requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6069shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6070loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6071linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6072application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6073way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6074all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6075search for each symbol reference.
6076
6077The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6078doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6079that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6080functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6081the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6082required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6083that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6084versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6085the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6086
6087There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6088first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6089source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6090script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6091maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6092@smallexample
6093__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6094@end smallexample
6095@noindent
6096in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6097be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6098The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
96a94295
L
6099@samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6100takes precedence over a version script.
252b5132
RH
6101
6102The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6103function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6104an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6105version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6106linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6107
6108To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6109source file. Here is an example:
6110
6111@smallexample
6112__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6113__asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6114__asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6115__asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6116@end smallexample
6117
6118In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6119unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6120example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6121@samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6122
6123When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6124some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6125this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6126@samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6127declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6128you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6129
6130If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6131within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
36f63dca 6132(i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
252b5132
RH
6133specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6134
cb840a31
L
6135You can also specify the language in the version script:
6136
6137@smallexample
6138VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6139@end smallexample
6140
c0065db7 6141The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
cb840a31
L
6142The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6143demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
bb1515f2
MF
6144patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6145@samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
cb840a31 6146
86043bbb
MM
6147Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6148described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6149or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6150the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6151whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6152cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6153might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6154should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6155expect when you upgrade.
6156
252b5132
RH
6157@node Expressions
6158@section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6159@cindex expressions
6160@cindex arithmetic
6161The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
6162that of C expressions. All expressions are evaluated as integers. All
6163expressions are evaluated in the same size, which is 32 bits if both the
6164host and target are 32 bits, and is otherwise 64 bits.
6165
6166You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6167
6168The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6169expressions.
6170
6171@menu
6172* Constants:: Constants
0c71d759 6173* Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
252b5132 6174* Symbols:: Symbol Names
ecca9871 6175* Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
252b5132
RH
6176* Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6177* Operators:: Operators
6178* Evaluation:: Evaluation
6179* Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6180* Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6181@end menu
6182
6183@node Constants
6184@subsection Constants
6185@cindex integer notation
6186@cindex constants in linker scripts
6187All constants are integers.
6188
6189As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6190octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
8a308ae8 6191hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
11e7fd74 6192@samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
8a308ae8
NC
6193@samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6194value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
252b5132
RH
6195
6196@cindex scaled integers
6197@cindex K and M integer suffixes
6198@cindex M and K integer suffixes
6199@cindex suffixes for integers
6200@cindex integer suffixes
6201In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6202constant by
6203@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6204@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6205@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6206@code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6207@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6208@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6209@tex
6210${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6211@end tex
6212@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
8a308ae8
NC
6213respectively. For example, the following
6214all refer to the same quantity:
6215
252b5132 6216@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6217_fourk_1 = 4K;
6218_fourk_2 = 4096;
6219_fourk_3 = 0x1000;
8a308ae8 6220_fourk_4 = 10000o;
252b5132
RH
6221@end smallexample
6222
8a308ae8
NC
6223Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6224conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6225
0c71d759
NC
6226@node Symbolic Constants
6227@subsection Symbolic Constants
6228@cindex symbolic constants
6229@kindex CONSTANT
a094d01f 6230It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
0c71d759
NC
6231the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6232
6233@table @code
6234@item MAXPAGESIZE
6235@kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6236The target's maximum page size.
6237
6238@item COMMONPAGESIZE
6239@kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6240The target's default page size.
6241@end table
6242
6243So for example:
6244
6245@smallexample
9d5777a3 6246 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
0c71d759
NC
6247@end smallexample
6248
6249will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6250supported by the target.
6251
252b5132
RH
6252@node Symbols
6253@subsection Symbol Names
6254@cindex symbol names
6255@cindex names
6256@cindex quoted symbol names
6257@kindex "
6258Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6259and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6260Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6261specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6262keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6263@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6264"SECTION" = 9;
6265"with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
252b5132
RH
6266@end smallexample
6267
6268Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6269to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6270whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6271
ecca9871
L
6272@node Orphan Sections
6273@subsection Orphan Sections
6274@cindex orphan
6275Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6276are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6277script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
a87ded7b
AB
6278output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6279in which to place the orphaned input section.
6280
6281If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6282an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6283placed at the end of that output section.
6284
6285If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6286sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6287name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6288orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6289one new output section.
6290
6291If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6292then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
e299b355
AM
6293in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6294linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6295attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6296sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6297support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
ecca9871 6298
a05a5b64
TP
6299The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6300(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
c005eb9e
AB
6301output sections an orphan is placed in.
6302
252b5132
RH
6303@node Location Counter
6304@subsection The Location Counter
6305@kindex .
6306@cindex dot
6307@cindex location counter
6308@cindex current output location
6309The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6310current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6311location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6312within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6313anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6314
6315@cindex holes
6316Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6317moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
dc0b6aa0
AM
6318location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6319and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6320doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
252b5132
RH
6321
6322@smallexample
6323SECTIONS
6324@{
6325 output :
6326 @{
6327 file1(.text)
6328 . = . + 1000;
6329 file2(.text)
6330 . += 1000;
6331 file3(.text)
563e308f 6332 @} = 0x12345678;
252b5132
RH
6333@}
6334@end smallexample
6335@noindent
6336In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6337located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6338followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6339@file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
563e308f 6340@samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
252b5132
RH
6341specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6342
5c6bbab8
NC
6343@cindex dot inside sections
6344Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6345current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
69da35b5 6346statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
5c6bbab8
NC
6347absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6348however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6349not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6350
6351@smallexample
6352SECTIONS
6353@{
6354 . = 0x100
6355 .text: @{
6356 *(.text)
6357 . = 0x200
6358 @}
6359 . = 0x500
6360 .data: @{
6361 *(.data)
6362 . += 0x600
6363 @}
6364@}
6365@end smallexample
6366
6367The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6368and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6369the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6370much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6371move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6372and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6373the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6374the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6375
b5666f2f
AM
6376@cindex dot outside sections
6377Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6378output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6379needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6380
6381@smallexample
6382SECTIONS
6383@{
6384 start_of_text = . ;
6385 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6386 end_of_text = . ;
6387
6388 start_of_data = . ;
6389 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6390 end_of_data = . ;
6391@}
6392@end smallexample
6393
6394If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6395not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6396between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6397should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6398blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6399the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6400sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6401statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6402special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6403place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6404as follows:
6405
6406@smallexample
6407SECTIONS
6408@{
6409 start_of_text = . ;
6410 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6411 end_of_text = . ;
6412
6413 start_of_data = . ;
6414 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6415 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6416 end_of_data = . ;
6417@}
6418@end smallexample
6419
6420This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6421@code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6422placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6423assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6424a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6425section. So you could write:
6426
6427@smallexample
6428SECTIONS
6429@{
6430 start_of_text = . ;
6431 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6432 end_of_text = . ;
6433
6434 . = . ;
6435 start_of_data = . ;
6436 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6437 end_of_data = . ;
6438@}
6439@end smallexample
6440
6441Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6442@code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6443
252b5132
RH
6444@need 2000
6445@node Operators
6446@subsection Operators
6447@cindex operators for arithmetic
6448@cindex arithmetic operators
6449@cindex precedence in expressions
6450The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6451the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6452@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6453@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6454@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6455@smallexample
6456precedence associativity Operators Notes
6457(highest)
64581 left ! - ~ (1)
64592 left * / %
64603 left + -
64614 left >> <<
64625 left == != > < <= >=
64636 left &
64647 left |
64658 left &&
64669 left ||
646710 right ? :
646811 right &= += -= *= /= (2)
6469(lowest)
6470@end smallexample
6471Notes:
a1ab1d2a 6472(1) Prefix operators
252b5132
RH
6473(2) @xref{Assignments}.
6474@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6475@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6476@tex
6477\vskip \baselineskip
6478%"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6479\hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6480\hrule
6481\halign
6482{\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6483height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6484&Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6485height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6486\noalign{\hrule}
6487height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6488&highest&&&&&\cr
6489% '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
a1ab1d2a 6490&1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
252b5132
RH
6491&2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6492&3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6493&4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
6494&5&&left&&== != > < <= >=&\cr
6495&6&&left&&\&&\cr
6496&7&&left&&|&\cr
6497&8&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6498&9&&left&&||&\cr
6499&10&&right&&? :&\cr
6500&11&&right&&\qquad\&= += -= *= /=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6501&lowest&&&&&\cr
6502height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6503\hrule}
6504@end tex
6505@iftex
6506{
6507@obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6508@dag@quad Prefix operators.
6509@ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6510}
6511@end iftex
6512@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6513
6514@node Evaluation
6515@subsection Evaluation
6516@cindex lazy evaluation
6517@cindex expression evaluation order
6518The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6519an expression when absolutely necessary.
6520
6521The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6522address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6523regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6524as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6525
6526However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6527until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6528other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6529for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6530
6531The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6532assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6533allocation.
6534
6535Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6536@samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6537
6538If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6539available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6540following
6541@smallexample
6542@group
6543SECTIONS
6544 @{
a1ab1d2a 6545 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
252b5132
RH
6546 @{ *(.text) @}
6547 @}
6548@end group
6549@end smallexample
6550@noindent
6551will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6552address}.
6553
6554@node Expression Section
6555@subsection The Section of an Expression
6556@cindex expression sections
6557@cindex absolute expressions
6558@cindex relative expressions
6559@cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6560@cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6561@cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
7542af2a
AM
6562Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6563relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6564using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6565value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6566symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6567operations.
6568
abf4be64
AM
6569Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6570section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6571address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6572@code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6573functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
01554a74
AM
6574One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6575(@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
5c3049d2
AM
6576differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6577versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6578section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6579Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
01554a74
AM
6580absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6581given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6582everywhere.
5c3049d2
AM
6583
6584In the following simple example,
252b5132 6585
7542af2a
AM
6586@smallexample
6587@group
6588SECTIONS
6589 @{
6590 . = 0x100;
6591 __executable_start = 0x100;
6592 .data :
6593 @{
6594 . = 0x10;
6595 __data_start = 0x10;
6596 *(.data)
6597 @}
6598 @dots{}
6599 @}
6600@end group
6601@end smallexample
252b5132 6602
7542af2a
AM
6603both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6604address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6605@code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6606section in the second two assignments.
252b5132 6607
5c3049d2
AM
6608For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6609addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
7542af2a
AM
6610
6611@itemize @bullet
6612@item
c05f749e
AM
6613Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6614operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6615absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6616@item
7542af2a
AM
6617Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6618relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6619and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6620@item
c05f749e
AM
6621Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6622in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6623address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6624before applying the operator.
7542af2a
AM
6625@end itemize
6626
6627The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
6628
6629@itemize @bullet
6630@item
6631An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
6632@item
6633The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
6634@item
9bc8bb33 6635The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
11e7fd74 6636relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
94b41882
AM
6637(after above conversions) is also a number when
6638@code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
6639but an absolute address otherwise.
9bc8bb33
AM
6640@item
6641The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
6642relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
6643section as the relative operand(s).
7542af2a
AM
6644@item
6645The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
6646conversions) is an absolute address.
6647@end itemize
252b5132
RH
6648
6649You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
6650to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
6651create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
6652section @samp{.data}:
6653@smallexample
6654SECTIONS
6655 @{
6656 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
6657 @}
6658@end smallexample
6659@noindent
6660If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
6661@samp{.data} section.
6662
7542af2a
AM
6663Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
6664particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
6665
252b5132
RH
6666@node Builtin Functions
6667@subsection Builtin Functions
6668@cindex functions in expressions
6669The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
6670use in linker script expressions.
6671
6672@table @code
6673@item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6674@kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6675@cindex expression, absolute
6676Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
6677of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
6678value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
6679normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
6680
6681@item ADDR(@var{section})
6682@kindex ADDR(@var{section})
6683@cindex section address in expression
7542af2a 6684Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
252b5132 6685script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
7542af2a
AM
6686the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
6687@code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
6688@code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
6689the other two will be absolute:
252b5132
RH
6690@smallexample
6691@group
6692SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6693 .output1 :
a1ab1d2a 6694 @{
252b5132
RH
6695 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
6696 @dots{}
6697 @}
6698 .output :
6699 @{
6700 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
6701 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
6702 @}
6703@dots{} @}
6704@end group
6705@end smallexample
6706
876f4090
NS
6707@item ALIGN(@var{align})
6708@itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6709@kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
6710@kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
252b5132
RH
6711@cindex round up location counter
6712@cindex align location counter
876f4090
NS
6713@cindex round up expression
6714@cindex align expression
6715Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
6716to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
6717doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
6718arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
6719expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
e0a3af22 6720equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
876f4090
NS
6721
6722Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
6723next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
6724variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
6725input sections:
252b5132
RH
6726@smallexample
6727@group
6728SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6729 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
6730 *(.data)
6731 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
6732 @}
6733@dots{} @}
6734@end group
6735@end smallexample
6736@noindent
6737The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
6738a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
6739a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
6740of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
6741
6742The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
6743
362c1d1a
NS
6744@item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6745@kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6746@cindex section alignment
6747Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6748been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6749evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6750the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the first
6751value in that section.
6752@smallexample
6753@group
6754SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6755 .output @{
6756 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
6757 @dots{}
6758 @}
6759@dots{} @}
6760@end group
6761@end smallexample
6762
252b5132
RH
6763@item BLOCK(@var{exp})
6764@kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
6765This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
6766scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
6767section.
6768
2d20f7bf
JJ
6769@item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6770@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6771This is equivalent to either
6772@smallexample
6773(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
6774@end smallexample
6775or
6776@smallexample
fe6052e1
AM
6777(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
6778 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
2d20f7bf
JJ
6779@end smallexample
6780@noindent
6781depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
6782for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
6783@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
6784If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
6785memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
6786bytes in the on-disk file.
6787
6788This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
6789any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
6790@var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
def5c83c
AM
6791be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
6792running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
6793that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
6794page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
2d20f7bf
JJ
6795
6796@noindent
6797Example:
6798@smallexample
6799 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
6800@end smallexample
6801
6802@item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6803@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6804This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
6805evaluation purposes.
6806
6807@smallexample
6808 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
6809@end smallexample
6810
a4f5ad88
JJ
6811@item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6812@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6813This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
eec2f3ed 6814@samp{-z relro} option is used.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6815When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
6816does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
def5c83c
AM
6817@var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
6818argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
6819script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
eec2f3ed
AM
6820@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
6821padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
6822section alignment.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6823
6824@smallexample
6825 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
6826@end smallexample
6827
252b5132
RH
6828@item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6829@kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6830@cindex symbol defaults
6831Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
420e579c
HPN
6832defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
6833return 0. You can use this function to provide
252b5132
RH
6834default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
6835shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
6836the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
6837existed, its value is preserved:
6838
6839@smallexample
6840@group
6841SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6842 .text : @{
6843 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
6844 @dots{}
6845 @}
6846 @dots{}
6847@}
6848@end group
6849@end smallexample
6850
3ec57632
NC
6851@item LENGTH(@var{memory})
6852@kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
6853Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6854
252b5132
RH
6855@item LOADADDR(@var{section})
6856@kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
6857@cindex section load address in expression
7542af2a 6858Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
252b5132
RH
6859Section LMA}).
6860
2e53f7d6
NC
6861@item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6862@kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6863Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
6864@code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
6865
252b5132
RH
6866@kindex MAX
6867@item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6868Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6869
6870@kindex MIN
6871@item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6872Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6873
6874@item NEXT(@var{exp})
6875@kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
6876@cindex unallocated address, next
6877Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
6878This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
6879use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
6880output file, the two functions are equivalent.
6881
3ec57632
NC
6882@item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6883@kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6884Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6885
ba916c8a
MM
6886@item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6887@kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6888Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
c5da8c7d
NC
6889value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
6890@samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
6891will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
6892can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7542af2a 6893``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
ba916c8a
MM
6894name.
6895
252b5132
RH
6896@item SIZEOF(@var{section})
6897@kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
6898@cindex section size
6899Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6900been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6901evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6902@code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical values:
6903@smallexample
6904@group
6905SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6906 .output @{
6907 .start = . ;
6908 @dots{}
6909 .end = . ;
6910 @}
6911 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
6912 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
6913@dots{} @}
6914@end group
6915@end smallexample
6916
6917@item SIZEOF_HEADERS
6918@itemx sizeof_headers
6919@kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
6920@cindex header size
6921Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
6922information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
6923this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
6924choose, to facilitate paging.
6925
6926@cindex not enough room for program headers
6927@cindex program headers, not enough room
6928When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
6929@code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
6930number of program headers before it has determined all the section
6931addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
6932additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
6933room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
6934the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
6935script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
6936you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
6937command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
6938@end table
6939
6940@node Implicit Linker Scripts
6941@section Implicit Linker Scripts
6942@cindex implicit linker scripts
6943If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
6944an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
6945linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
6946linker will report an error.
6947
6948An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
6949
6950Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
6951assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
6952commands.
6953
6954Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
6955at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
6956read. This can affect archive searching.
6957
bf6d8037
HC
6958@node Plugins
6959@chapter Linker Plugins
6960
6961@cindex plugins
6962@cindex linker plugins
6963The linker can use dynamically loaded plugins to modify its behavior.
6964For example, the link-time optimization feature that some compilers
6965support is implemented with a linker plugin.
6966
6967Currently there is only one plugin shipped by default, but more may
6968be added here later.
6969
6970@menu
6971* libdep Plugin:: Static Library Dependencies Plugin
6972@end menu
6973
6974@node libdep Plugin
6975@section Static Library Dependencies Plugin
6976@cindex static library dependencies
6977Originally, static libraries were contained in an archive file consisting
6978just of a collection of relocatable object files. Later they evolved to
6979optionally include a symbol table, to assist in finding the needed objects
6980within a library. There their evolution ended, and dynamic libraries
6981rose to ascendance.
6982
6983One useful feature of dynamic libraries was that, more than just collecting
6984multiple objects into a single file, they also included a list of their
6985dependencies, such that one could specify just the name of a single dynamic
6986library at link time, and all of its dependencies would be implicitly
6987referenced as well. But static libraries lacked this feature, so if a
6988link invocation was switched from using dynamic libraries to static
6989libraries, the link command would usually fail unless it was rewritten to
6990explicitly list the dependencies of the static library.
6991
6992The GNU @command{ar} utility now supports a @option{--record-libdeps} option
6993to embed dependency lists into static libraries as well, and the @file{libdep}
6994plugin may be used to read this dependency information at link time. The
6995dependency information is stored as a single string, carrying @option{-l}
6996and @option{-L} arguments as they would normally appear in a linker
6997command line. As such, the information can be written with any text
6998utility and stored into any archive, even if GNU @command{ar} is not
6999being used to create the archive. The information is stored in an
7000archive member named @samp{__.LIBDEP}.
7001
7002For example, given a library @file{libssl.a} that depends on another
7003library @file{libcrypto.a} which may be found in @file{/usr/local/lib},
7004the @samp{__.LIBDEP} member of @file{libssl.a} would contain
7005
7006@smallexample
7007-L/usr/local/lib -lcrypto
7008@end smallexample
7009
252b5132
RH
7010@ifset GENERIC
7011@node Machine Dependent
7012@chapter Machine Dependent Features
7013
7014@cindex machine dependencies
ff5dcc92
SC
7015@command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
7016sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
252b5132
RH
7017functionality are not listed.
7018
7019@menu
36f63dca
NC
7020@ifset H8300
7021* H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
7022@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
7023@ifset M68HC11
7024* M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7025@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
7026@ifset ARM
7027* ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
7028@end ifset
7029@ifset HPPA
7030* HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
7031@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
7032@ifset M68K
7033* M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7034@end ifset
833794fc
MR
7035@ifset MIPS
7036* MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7037@end ifset
3c3bdf30 7038@ifset MMIX
36f63dca 7039* MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
3c3bdf30 7040@end ifset
2469cfa2 7041@ifset MSP430
36f63dca 7042* MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
2469cfa2 7043@end ifset
35c08157
KLC
7044@ifset NDS32
7045* NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
7046@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
7047@ifset NIOSII
7048* Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7049@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
7050@ifset POWERPC
7051* PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7052@end ifset
7053@ifset POWERPC64
7054* PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7055@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
7056@ifset S/390
7057* S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7058@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
7059@ifset SPU
7060* SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
7061@end ifset
74459f0e 7062@ifset TICOFF
ff5dcc92 7063* TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
74459f0e 7064@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
7065@ifset WIN32
7066* WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
7067@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
7068@ifset XTENSA
7069* Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
7070@end ifset
252b5132
RH
7071@end menu
7072@end ifset
7073
252b5132
RH
7074@ifset H8300
7075@ifclear GENERIC
7076@raisesections
7077@end ifclear
7078
7079@node H8/300
ff5dcc92 7080@section @command{ld} and the H8/300
252b5132
RH
7081
7082@cindex H8/300 support
ff5dcc92 7083For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
252b5132
RH
7084you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7085
7086@table @emph
7087@cindex relaxing on H8/300
7088@item relaxing address modes
ff5dcc92 7089@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
252b5132
RH
7090targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7091program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7092respectively.
7093
7094@cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7095@item synthesizing instructions
81f5558e 7096@c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
ff5dcc92 7097@command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
252b5132
RH
7098sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7099page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7100(That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7101@samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7102top page of memory).
1502569c 7103
81f5558e
NC
7104@command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7105indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7106displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7107the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7108@code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7109whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7110range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7111
1502569c 7112@item bit manipulation instructions
c0065db7 7113@command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
1502569c 7114biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
c0065db7 7115which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
1502569c
NC
7116page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7117(That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
c0065db7 7118@samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c
NC
7119the top page of memory).
7120
7121@item system control instructions
c0065db7
RM
7122@command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
712332 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
1502569c
NC
7124changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7125(That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
c0065db7 7126@samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c 7127the top page of memory).
252b5132
RH
7128@end table
7129
7130@ifclear GENERIC
7131@lowersections
7132@end ifclear
7133@end ifset
7134
36f63dca 7135@ifclear GENERIC
c2dcd04e 7136@ifset Renesas
36f63dca 7137@c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
c2dcd04e
NC
7138@c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7139@node Renesas
7140@chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
36f63dca 7141
c2dcd04e
NC
7142@command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7143H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7144options are required for these chips.
36f63dca
NC
7145@end ifset
7146@end ifclear
7147
36f63dca
NC
7148@ifset ARM
7149@ifclear GENERIC
7150@raisesections
7151@end ifclear
7152
93fd0973
SC
7153@ifset M68HC11
7154@ifclear GENERIC
7155@raisesections
7156@end ifclear
7157
7158@node M68HC11/68HC12
7159@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7160
7161@cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7162
7163@subsection Linker Relaxation
7164
7165For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7166optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7167
7168@table @emph
7169@cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7170@item relaxing address modes
7171@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7172targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7173program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7174respectively.
7175
7176@command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7177transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7178page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7179
7180@item relaxing gcc instruction group
7181When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7182of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7183addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7184@code{bset} instructions.
7185
7186@end table
7187
7188@subsection Trampoline Generation
7189
7190@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7191@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7192For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7193call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
c0065db7 7194will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
93fd0973
SC
7195trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7196case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7197point to the function trampoline.
7198
7199@ifclear GENERIC
7200@lowersections
7201@end ifclear
7202@end ifset
7203
36f63dca 7204@node ARM
3674e28a 7205@section @command{ld} and the ARM family
36f63dca
NC
7206
7207@cindex ARM interworking support
7208@kindex --support-old-code
7209For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
b45619c0 7210between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
36f63dca
NC
7211been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7212line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7213libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
a05a5b64 7214option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
36f63dca
NC
7215given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7216which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7217the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7218non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7219
7220@cindex thumb entry point
7221@cindex entry point, thumb
7222@kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7223The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7224@samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7225But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7226branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7227executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7228
ce11ba6c
KT
7229@cindex PE import table prefixing
7230@kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7231The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7232the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
11e7fd74 7233element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
ce11ba6c
KT
7234import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7235
e489d0ae
PB
7236@cindex BE8
7237@kindex --be8
7238The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
080bb7bb
NC
7239executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7240objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7241option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7242little-endian code.
e489d0ae 7243
3674e28a
PB
7244@cindex TARGET1
7245@kindex --target1-rel
7246@kindex --target1-abs
7247The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7248@samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7249or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7250and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7251
7252@cindex TARGET2
7253@kindex --target2=@var{type}
7254The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7255@samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7256meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7257@table @samp
7258@item rel
eeac373a
PB
7259@samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7260@item abs
7261@samp{R_ARM_ABS32} (arm*-*-symbianelf)
3674e28a
PB
7262@item got-rel
7263@samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7264@end table
7265
319850b4
JB
7266@cindex FIX_V4BX
7267@kindex --fix-v4bx
7268The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7269specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7270interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7271also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7272
7273In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7274linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7275@code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7276
7277In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7278relocations are ignored.
7279
845b51d6
PB
7280@cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7281@kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7282Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7283relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7284
7285@smallexample
7286TST rM, #1
7287MOVEQ PC, rM
7288BX Rn
7289@end smallexample
7290
7291This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7292and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
11e7fd74 7293condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
845b51d6 7294
33bfe774
JB
7295@cindex USE_BLX
7296@kindex --use-blx
7297The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7298BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7299situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7300code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7301each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7302
7303This option is enabled implicitly for SymbianOS, so there is no need to
7304specify it if you are using that target.
7305
c6dd86c6
JB
7306@cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7307@kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7308The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7309bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7310instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7311to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7312the support code can read the intended values.
7313
7314The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7315intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7316and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7317intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7318full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7319you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7320
7321If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7322enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7323@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7324mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7325vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7326@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7327
7328If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7329potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7330such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7331first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7332instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7333the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7334are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7335
2de70689
MGD
7336@cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7337@kindex --fix-arm1176
7338@kindex --no-fix-arm1176
9d5777a3
RM
7339The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7340in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7341are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
2de70689
MGD
7342unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7343
9d5777a3 7344Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
11e7fd74 7345Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
2de70689
MGD
7346http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7347
a504d23a
LA
7348@cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7349@kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7350
7351The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7352workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7353the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7354off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7355the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7356core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7357integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7358VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7359
7360The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7361necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7362
7363The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7364@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7365STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7366linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7367@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7368
7369If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7370potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7371such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7372replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7373branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7374then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7375
7376The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7377the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7378
7379The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7380they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7381there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7382occurs.
7383
7384The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7385PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7386large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7387cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7388occurs.
7389
bf21ed78
MS
7390@cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7391@kindex --no-enum-size-warning
726150b7 7392The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
bf21ed78
MS
7393warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7394enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7395linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7396using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7397not be diagnosed.
a9dc9481
JM
7398
7399@cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7400@kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7401The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7402warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7403@code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7404linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7405using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
bf21ed78 7406
726150b7
NC
7407@cindex PIC_VENEER
7408@kindex --pic-veneer
7409The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7410ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7411is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7412@samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7413
7414@cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7415@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7416The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7417code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7418perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7419placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
a05a5b64 7420controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
726150b7 7421The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
11e7fd74 7422duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
726150b7
NC
7423group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7424code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7425where they should be placed.
7426
7427The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7428@option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
07d72278 7429placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
726150b7
NC
7430branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7431placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7432value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7433exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7434A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7435linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7436from the input sections.
7437
7438The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7439@samp{N = +1}.
7440
1a51c1a4
NC
7441Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7442only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7443otherwise.
7444
1db37fe6
YG
7445@cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7446@kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7447@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7448The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7449
7450The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7451
68fcca92
JW
7452@cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7453@kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7454@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7455The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7456
7457Please contact ARM for further details.
7458
1db37fe6
YG
7459@kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7460@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7461@cindex Merging exidx entries
7462The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7463
7464@kindex --long-plt
7465@cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7466The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7467which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7468entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7469
1f56df9d
JW
7470@kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7471@cindex AArch64 rela addend
7472The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7473link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7474
4ba2ef8f
TP
7475@cindex Placement of SG veneers
7476All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
a05a5b64 7477Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
4ba2ef8f
TP
7478@samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7479veneers in memory.
7480
54ddd295
TP
7481@kindex --cmse-implib
7482@cindex Secure gateway import library
7483The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7484specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7485secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7486executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7487
0955507f
TP
7488@kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7489@cindex Input import library
7490The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7491must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7492given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7493in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7494@samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7495library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7496library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7497for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7498specified.
7499
36f63dca
NC
7500@ifclear GENERIC
7501@lowersections
7502@end ifclear
7503@end ifset
7504
7505@ifset HPPA
7506@ifclear GENERIC
7507@raisesections
7508@end ifclear
7509
7510@node HPPA ELF32
7511@section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7512@cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7513@kindex --multi-subspace
7514When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7515import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7516The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7517stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7518multiple sub-spaces.
7519
7520@cindex HPPA stub grouping
7521@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7522Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7523stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7524@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7525sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7526a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7527the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7528conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7529prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7530A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7531branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7532@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7533@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7534detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7535positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7536
7537Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7538single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7539create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7540large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7541
7542@ifclear GENERIC
7543@lowersections
7544@end ifclear
7545@end ifset
7546
7fb9f789
NC
7547@ifset M68K
7548@ifclear GENERIC
7549@raisesections
7550@end ifclear
7551
7552@node M68K
7553@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7554
7555@cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7556@kindex --got=@var{type}
7557The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7558The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7559@samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7560the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7561@samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7562entries only at non-negative offsets.
7563@samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7564entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7565support such GOTs.
7566@samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7567output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7568file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7569files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7570
7571@ifclear GENERIC
7572@lowersections
7573@end ifclear
7574@end ifset
7575
833794fc
MR
7576@ifset MIPS
7577@ifclear GENERIC
7578@raisesections
7579@end ifclear
7580
7581@node MIPS
7582@section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7583
7584@cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7585@kindex --insn32
7586@kindex --no-insn32
7587The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7588microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7589in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7590used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7591or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7592including 16-bit ones where possible.
7593
8b10b0b3
MR
7594@cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7595@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7596@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7597The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7598control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7599@samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7600relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7601calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7602relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7603instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7604or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7605the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7606
833794fc
MR
7607@ifclear GENERIC
7608@lowersections
7609@end ifclear
7610@end ifset
7611
36f63dca
NC
7612@ifset MMIX
7613@ifclear GENERIC
7614@raisesections
7615@end ifclear
7616
7617@node MMIX
7618@section @code{ld} and MMIX
7619For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
7620@code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
7621understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
7622can translate between the two formats.
7623
7624There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
7625Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
7626registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
7627equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
7628@samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
7629global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
7630this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
7631symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
7632
7a2de473
HPN
7633Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
7634@code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
7635The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
7636of a section.
36f63dca
NC
7637
7638Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
7639are left out from an mmo file.
7640
7641@ifclear GENERIC
7642@lowersections
7643@end ifclear
7644@end ifset
7645
7646@ifset MSP430
7647@ifclear GENERIC
7648@raisesections
7649@end ifclear
7650
7651@node MSP430
7652@section @code{ld} and MSP430
7653For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
7654will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
7655just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
7656
7657@cindex MSP430 extra sections
7658The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
7659
7660@table @code
7661@item @samp{.vectors}
7662Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
7663
7664@item @samp{.bootloader}
7665Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
7666in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7667
7668@item @samp{.infomem}
7669Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
7670this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7671
c0065db7 7672@item @samp{.infomemnobits}
36f63dca
NC
7673This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
7674in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
7675
7676@item @samp{.noinit}
7677Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
7678
c0065db7 7679The last two sections are used by gcc.
36f63dca
NC
7680@end table
7681
7ef3addb
JL
7682@table @option
7683@cindex MSP430 Options
7684@kindex --code-region
7685@item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7686This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
7687argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
7688using this option.
7689
7690@kindex --data-region
7691@item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7692This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
7693[either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
7694for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
7695
7696@kindex --disable-sec-transformation
7697@item --disable-sec-transformation
7698Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
7699and @code{--data-region} options.
7700This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
7701wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
7702not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
7703@end table
7704
36f63dca
NC
7705@ifclear GENERIC
7706@lowersections
7707@end ifclear
7708@end ifset
7709
35c08157
KLC
7710@ifset NDS32
7711@ifclear GENERIC
7712@raisesections
7713@end ifclear
7714
7715@node NDS32
7716@section @code{ld} and NDS32
7717@kindex relaxing on NDS32
7718For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
7719relaxes objects according to these options.
7720
7721@table @code
7722@item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
7723Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
7724
7725@item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
7726Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
7727
7728@item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
7729Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
7730
7731@item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
7732Export the EX9 table after linking.
7733
7734@item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
7735Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
7736
7737@item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
7738Update the existing EX9 table.
7739
7740@item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
7741Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
7742
7743@item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
7744Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
7745
7746@item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
7747Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
7748
7749@item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
7750Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
7751@end table
7752
7753@ifclear GENERIC
7754@lowersections
7755@end ifclear
7756@end ifset
7757
78058a5e
SL
7758@ifset NIOSII
7759@ifclear GENERIC
7760@raisesections
7761@end ifclear
7762
7763@node Nios II
7764@section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7765@cindex Nios II call relaxation
7766@kindex --relax on Nios II
7767
7768Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
7769transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
7770which may result in @command{ld} giving
7771@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7772The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
7773trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
7774outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
7775trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
7776be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
7777larger than 256MB.
7778
7779The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
7780is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
7781@option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
7782locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
7783source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
7784register as a temporary.
7785
7786Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
7787relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
7788option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
7789
7790@ifclear GENERIC
7791@lowersections
7792@end ifclear
7793@end ifset
7794
2a60a7a8
AM
7795@ifset POWERPC
7796@ifclear GENERIC
7797@raisesections
7798@end ifclear
7799
7800@node PowerPC ELF32
7801@section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7802@cindex PowerPC long branches
7803@kindex --relax on PowerPC
7804Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
7805displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
7806@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7807@samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
7808the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
7809section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
c8a1f254
NS
7810section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
7811@samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
7812both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
7813considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
2a60a7a8
AM
7814
7815@cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
7816@table @option
7817@cindex PowerPC PLT
7818@kindex --bss-plt
7819@item --bss-plt
7820Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
7821generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
7822the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
7823writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
7824@command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
7825PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
7826compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
7827BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
7828
016687f8
AM
7829@kindex --secure-plt
7830@item --secure-plt
7831@command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
7832@samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
7833when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
7834layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
7835style BSS PLT.
7836
2a60a7a8
AM
7837@cindex PowerPC GOT
7838@kindex --sdata-got
7839@item --sdata-got
7840The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
7841sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
7842@code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
7843section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
7844@code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
7845@code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
7846@samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
7847@code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
7848PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
7849pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
7850GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
7851really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
7852
7853@cindex PowerPC stub symbols
7854@kindex --emit-stub-syms
7855@item --emit-stub-syms
7856This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7857symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7858
7859@cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
7860@kindex --no-tls-optimize
7861@item --no-tls-optimize
7862PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7863sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7864disable the optimization.
7865@end table
7866
7867@ifclear GENERIC
7868@lowersections
7869@end ifclear
7870@end ifset
7871
7872@ifset POWERPC64
7873@ifclear GENERIC
7874@raisesections
7875@end ifclear
7876
7877@node PowerPC64 ELF64
7878@section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7879
7880@cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
7881@table @option
7882@cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
7883@kindex --stub-group-size
7884@item --stub-group-size
7885Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
7886by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7887@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7888sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7889a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7890the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7891conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7892prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7893A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7894branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7895@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7896@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7897detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7898positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7899
7900Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7901single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7902create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7903large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7904
7905@cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
7906@kindex --emit-stub-syms
7907@item --emit-stub-syms
7908This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7909symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7910
7911@cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
7912@kindex --dotsyms
7913@kindex --no-dotsyms
95421fb9
AM
7914@item --dotsyms
7915@itemx --no-dotsyms
2a60a7a8
AM
7916These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
7917in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
7918function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
7919code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
7920properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
7921to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
7922@samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
7923dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
7924feature.
7925
7ae4ea7d
AM
7926@cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
7927@kindex --save-restore-funcs
7928@kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
95421fb9
AM
7929@item --save-restore-funcs
7930@itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
7ae4ea7d
AM
7931These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
7932provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
7933@samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
7934function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
7935link.
7936
2a60a7a8
AM
7937@cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
7938@kindex --no-tls-optimize
7939@item --no-tls-optimize
7940PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7941sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7942disable the optimization.
7943
7c9cf415
AM
7944@cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
7945@kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
7946@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa
AM
7947@kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
7948@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
95421fb9
AM
7949@item --tls-get-addr-optimize
7950@itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa 7951These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
7c9cf415
AM
7952stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
7953an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
7954@code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
9e7028aa
AM
7955stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
7956generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
7957__tls_get_addr_opt.
7958Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
7959much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
7960an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
7961will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
7962@option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
7963and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
7964this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
7965Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
5cebc931 7966@option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
9e7028aa 7967register saves.
7c9cf415 7968
2a60a7a8
AM
7969@cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
7970@kindex --no-opd-optimize
7971@item --no-opd-optimize
7972PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
7973corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
e7fc76dd 7974the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
2a60a7a8
AM
7975Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
7976
7977@cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
7978@kindex --non-overlapping-opd
7979@item --non-overlapping-opd
7980Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
7981@code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
7982the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
7983entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
7984
7985@cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
7986@kindex --no-toc-optimize
7987@item --no-toc-optimize
7988PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
7989entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
7990reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
7991marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
7992marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
7993relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
7994unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
7995reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
7996discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
7997reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
7998code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
7999optimization.
8000
d882c988
AM
8001@cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
8002@kindex --no-inline-optimize
8003@item --no-inline-optimize
8004PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
8005marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
8006@code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
8007a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
8008locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
8009disables that optimization.
8010
2a60a7a8
AM
8011@cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
8012@kindex --no-multi-toc
8013@item --no-multi-toc
794e51c0
AM
8014If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
8015@code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
8016where TOC
2a60a7a8
AM
8017entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
8018total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
8019grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
8020TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
8021calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
8022help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
802364K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
8024Use this option to turn off this feature.
794e51c0
AM
8025
8026@cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
8027@kindex --no-toc-sort
8028@item --no-toc-sort
8029By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
8030happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
8031placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
8032with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
8033referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
8034@code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
8035results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
8036off this feature.
8037
8038@cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
8039@kindex --plt-align
8040@kindex --no-plt-align
8041@item --plt-align
8042@itemx --no-plt-align
8043Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
2420fff6
AM
8044aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
8045boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
8046specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
8047specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
8048if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
8049PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
794e51c0
AM
8050
8051@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
8052@kindex --plt-static-chain
8053@kindex --no-plt-static-chain
8054@item --plt-static-chain
8055@itemx --no-plt-static-chain
8056Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
8057chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
8058chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
8059
8060@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
8061@kindex --plt-thread-safe
8062@kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
8063@item --plt-thread-safe
1be5d8d3 8064@itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
794e51c0
AM
8065With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
8066lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
8067another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
8068order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
8069memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
8070barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
8071looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
8072seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
8073default behaviour.
8b5f1ed8
AM
8074
8075@cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
8076@kindex --plt-localentry
8077@kindex --no-plt-localentry
8078@item --plt-localentry
8079@itemx --no-localentry
8080ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
8081ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
8082(the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
8083Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
8084or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
8085functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
8086in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
d44c746a
AM
8087interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
8088including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
8089to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
8090complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
8091care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
d882c988
AM
8092
8093@cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
8094@kindex --power10-stubs
8095@kindex --no-power10-stubs
8096@item --power10-stubs
8097@itemx --no-power10-stubs
8098When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8099relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
e10a07b3
AM
8100linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8101for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
8102power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
d882c988
AM
8103power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8104allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
e10a07b3
AM
8105@option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8106auto mode.
2a60a7a8
AM
8107@end table
8108
8109@ifclear GENERIC
8110@lowersections
8111@end ifclear
8112@end ifset
8113
b4cbbe8f
AK
8114@ifset S/390
8115@ifclear GENERIC
8116@raisesections
8117@end ifclear
8118
8119@node S/390 ELF
8120@section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8121
8122@cindex S/390 ELF options
8123@table @option
8124
8125@cindex S/390
8126@kindex --s390-pgste
8127@item --s390-pgste
8128This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8129segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8130binaries marked that way.
8131@end table
8132
8133@ifclear GENERIC
8134@lowersections
8135@end ifclear
8136@end ifset
8137
49fa1e15
AM
8138@ifset SPU
8139@ifclear GENERIC
8140@raisesections
8141@end ifclear
8142
8143@node SPU ELF
8144@section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8145
8146@cindex SPU ELF options
8147@table @option
8148
8149@cindex SPU plugins
8150@kindex --plugin
8151@item --plugin
8152This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8153
8154@cindex SPU overlays
8155@kindex --no-overlays
8156@item --no-overlays
8157Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8158regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8159@command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8160turns off all this special overlay handling.
8161
8162@cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8163@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8164@item --emit-stub-syms
8165This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8166symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8167
8168@cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8169@kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8170@item --extra-overlay-stubs
8171This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8172function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8173on calls to non-overlay regions.
8174
8175@cindex SPU local store size
8176@kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8177@item --local-store=lo:hi
8178@command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8179the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8180range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8181
c0065db7 8182@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8183@kindex --stack-analysis
8184@item --stack-analysis
8185SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8186unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8187under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8188@command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8189@command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8190determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8191for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8192for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8193for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8194find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8195and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8196under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8197dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8198is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8199and calls will be given.
8200
c0065db7 8201@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8202@kindex --emit-stack-syms
8203@item --emit-stack-syms
8204This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8205in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8206These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8207functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8208functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8209such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8210The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
c0065db7 8211@code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
49fa1e15
AM
8212@end table
8213
8214@ifclear GENERIC
8215@lowersections
8216@end ifclear
8217@end ifset
8218
36f63dca
NC
8219@ifset TICOFF
8220@ifclear GENERIC
8221@raisesections
8222@end ifclear
8223
8224@node TI COFF
8225@section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8226@cindex TI COFF versions
8227@kindex --format=@var{version}
8228The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8229TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8230also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8231format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8232header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8233
8234@ifclear GENERIC
8235@lowersections
8236@end ifclear
8237@end ifset
8238
2ca22b03
NC
8239@ifset WIN32
8240@ifclear GENERIC
8241@raisesections
8242@end ifclear
8243
8244@node WIN32
8245@section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8246
c0065db7 8247This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
a05a5b64
TP
8248See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8249command-line options mentioned here.
2ca22b03
NC
8250
8251@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8252@cindex import libraries
8253@item import libraries
69da35b5 8254The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
2ca22b03 8255libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
69da35b5
NC
8256regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8257archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
2ca22b03 8258support for creating such libraries provided with the
a05a5b64 8259@samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
2ca22b03 8260
c0065db7
RM
8261@item exporting DLL symbols
8262@cindex exporting DLL symbols
dc8465bf
NC
8263The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8264
8265@table @emph
8266@item using auto-export functionality
8267@cindex using auto-export functionality
8268By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
a05a5b64 8269which is controlled by the following command-line options:
dc8465bf 8270
0a5d968e
NC
8271@itemize
8272@item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8273@item --exclude-symbols
8274@item --exclude-libs
e1c37eb5 8275@item --exclude-modules-for-implib
09e2aba4 8276@item --version-script
0a5d968e
NC
8277@end itemize
8278
09e2aba4
DK
8279When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8280(global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8281symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8282often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8283private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
9d5777a3 8284options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
09e2aba4
DK
8285exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8286final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8287
8288If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
0a5d968e
NC
8289command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8290if either of the following are true:
8291
8292@itemize
8293@item A DEF file is used.
8294@item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8295@end itemize
dc8465bf 8296
c0065db7
RM
8297@item using a DEF file
8298@cindex using a DEF file
dc8465bf
NC
8299Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8300an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8301exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8302name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
0a5d968e 8303command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
dc8465bf
NC
8304
8305@example
8306gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8307@end example
8308
0a5d968e
NC
8309Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8310@samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8311
dc8465bf
NC
8312Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8313
8314@example
4b5bd4e7 8315LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
dc8465bf
NC
8316
8317EXPORTS
8318foo
8319bar
8320_bar = bar
4b5bd4e7
DS
8321another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8322var1 DATA
7fcab871
KT
8323doo = foo == foo2
8324eoo DATA == var1
c0065db7 8325@end example
dc8465bf 8326
7fcab871 8327This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
4b5bd4e7
DS
8328symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8329alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8330by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8331@code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
7fcab871
KT
8332@code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8333export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8334in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8335symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
4b5bd4e7 8336
6b31ad16
DS
8337The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8338name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8339the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8340
b45619c0
NC
8341When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8342library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
6b31ad16 8343@code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
c0065db7 8344executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
6b31ad16
DS
8345
8346With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8347specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
c0065db7 8348non-default base address for the image.
6b31ad16
DS
8349
8350If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
a2877985
DS
8351or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8352filename specified on the command line.
6b31ad16 8353
4b5bd4e7
DS
8354The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8355
8356@example
8357EXPORTS
8358 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8359 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
7fcab871 8360 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
c0065db7 8361@end example
4b5bd4e7
DS
8362
8363Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8364@samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8365@samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8366@samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8367Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
7fcab871
KT
8368@samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8369string in import/export table for the symbol.
4b5bd4e7
DS
8370
8371The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8372
8373@code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8374will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8375by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8376linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8377library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8378
8379@code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8380The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8381the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8382@code{*_imp__foo}).
8383
8384@code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8385well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8386read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8387variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8388the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8389extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8390application will behave unexpectedly.
8391
8392@code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8393it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8394symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
de194d85 8395API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
4b5bd4e7 8396the DLL without an import library.
c0065db7 8397
4b5bd4e7
DS
8398See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8399other DEF file statements
dc8465bf
NC
8400
8401@cindex creating a DEF file
8402While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
a05a5b64 8403with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
0a5d968e
NC
8404
8405@item Using decorations
8406@cindex Using decorations
8407Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8408itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8409declared as:
8410
8411@example
8412__declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8413__declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8414@end example
8415
8416All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8417any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8418this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8419the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8420
8421Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
c0065db7 8422decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
0a5d968e
NC
8423instead:
8424
8425@example
8426__declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8427__declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8428@end example
8429
c0065db7
RM
8430This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8431when included by the library itself the header must declare the
0a5d968e
NC
8432variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8433code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
c0065db7 8434of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
0a5d968e
NC
8435omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8436@samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
b45619c0 8437information.
c0065db7 8438@end table
dc8465bf 8439
2ca22b03
NC
8440@cindex automatic data imports
8441@item automatic data imports
8442The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
69da35b5 8443by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
2ca22b03 8444compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
c0065db7 8445issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
69da35b5 8446code to these platforms, especially for large
2ca22b03 8447c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
c0065db7 8448initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
b45619c0 8449decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
c0065db7 8450platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
69da35b5
NC
8451command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8452The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8453suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8454trigger the feature's use.
8455
c0065db7 8456auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
69da35b5
NC
8457additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8458
c0065db7 8459"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
69da35b5
NC
8460documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8461
c0065db7
RM
8462The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8463occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8464One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
69da35b5
NC
8465below.
8466
8467@cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
c0065db7
RM
8468For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8469object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8470offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8471field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8472in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
69da35b5 8473without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
c0065db7 8474The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
69da35b5
NC
8475references.
8476
c0065db7
RM
8477The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8478be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8479themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8480runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8481compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8482support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
69da35b5
NC
8483run without error on an older system.
8484
c0065db7
RM
8485@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8486enabled as needed.
2ca22b03
NC
8487
8488@cindex direct linking to a dll
8489@item direct linking to a dll
8490The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8491including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
69da35b5 8492libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
b45619c0 8493traditional import library method, especially when linking large
c0065db7
RM
8494libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8495function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8496though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
69da35b5 8497storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
c0065db7 8498tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
69da35b5
NC
8499large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8500
c0065db7 8501Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
69da35b5 8502@samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
c0065db7 8503of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
69da35b5
NC
8504perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8505select the dll instead of an import library.
8506
2ca22b03 8507
69da35b5
NC
8508For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8509to find, in the first directory of its search path,
2ca22b03
NC
8510
8511@example
45e948fe
NC
8512libxxx.dll.a
8513xxx.dll.a
8514libxxx.a
8515xxx.lib
f6c4d4b1 8516libxxx.lib
69da35b5 8517cygxxx.dll (*)
45e948fe
NC
8518libxxx.dll
8519xxx.dll
2ca22b03
NC
8520@end example
8521
69da35b5
NC
8522before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8523
c0065db7
RM
8524(*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8525where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8526@samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8527file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
69da35b5
NC
8528@samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8529
c0065db7
RM
8530Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8531@samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
69da35b5
NC
8532was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8533various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8534could coexist on the same machine.
8535
2ca22b03
NC
8536The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8537applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
69da35b5 8538libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
2ca22b03
NC
8539
8540@example
8541bin/
8542 cygxxx.dll
8543lib/
8544 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
c0065db7 8545 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
2ca22b03
NC
8546@end example
8547
c0065db7
RM
8548Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8549done two ways:
2ca22b03
NC
8550
85511. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8552@example
8553gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8554@end example
2ca22b03 8555
69da35b5
NC
8556However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8557(@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8558@samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8559not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8560
2ca22b03
NC
85612. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8562directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8563should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8564making the app/dll.
8565
8566@example
8567ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
c0065db7 8568@end example
2ca22b03
NC
8569
8570Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8571
8572@example
8573gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8574@end example
69da35b5
NC
8575
8576This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8577perfectly legal
8578
8579@example
8580bin/
8581 cygxxx-5.dll
8582lib/
c0065db7 8583 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
69da35b5
NC
8584@end example
8585
dc8465bf 8586Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
69da35b5
NC
8587even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
8588@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
8589
8590Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
45e948fe 8591wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
69da35b5
NC
8592
85931. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
8594work with auto-imported data.
8595
dc8465bf
NC
85962. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
8597import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
8598symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
8599for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
8600possible to do this without an import lib.
69da35b5 8601
45e948fe
NC
86023. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
8603critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
8604in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
8605stdcall-decorated assembly names.
8606
69da35b5 8607So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
c0065db7
RM
8608true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
8609a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
8610binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
69da35b5
NC
8611massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
8612requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
8613will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
dc8465bf 8614
c0065db7 8615@item symbol aliasing
dc8465bf 8616@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8617@item adding additional names
8618Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
dc8465bf
NC
8619A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
8620exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
8621when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
c0065db7 8622import library. Consider the following DEF file:
dc8465bf 8623
c0065db7 8624@example
dc8465bf
NC
8625LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8626
8627EXPORTS
c0065db7 8628foo
dc8465bf 8629_foo = foo
c0065db7 8630@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8631
8632The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
8633
8634Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
8635source code using the "weak" attribute:
8636
c0065db7
RM
8637@example
8638void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
dc8465bf 8639void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
c0065db7 8640@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8641
8642See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
8643symbols.
8644
8645@item renaming symbols
8646Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
c0065db7 8647kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
dc8465bf
NC
8648@samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
8649DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
c0065db7 8650created). In the following example:
dc8465bf 8651
c0065db7 8652@example
dc8465bf
NC
8653LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8654
8655EXPORTS
8656_foo = foo
c0065db7 8657@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8658
8659The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
8660@samp{_foo}.
c0065db7 8661@end table
dc8465bf 8662
0a5d968e 8663Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
a05a5b64 8664unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
0a5d968e 8665If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
c0065db7
RM
8666@emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
8667that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
8668@samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
8669renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
8670to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
8671the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
8672In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
0a5d968e 8673which is probably not what you wanted.
c87db184
CF
8674
8675@cindex weak externals
8676@item weak externals
8677The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
8678weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
8679defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
8680are three variants of weak externals:
8681@itemize
8682@item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
8683called lazy externals.
8684@item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
8685This form is not presently implemented.
8686@item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
8687implemented.
8688@end itemize
8689As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
8690are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
8691uses a default value.
c1711530
DK
8692
8693@cindex aligned common symbols
8694@item aligned common symbols
8695As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
8696desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
8697the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
8698carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
8699by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
8700tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
8701but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
8702warnings about unknown linker directives.
5063daf7 8703
2ca22b03
NC
8704@end table
8705
8706@ifclear GENERIC
8707@lowersections
8708@end ifclear
8709@end ifset
8710
e0001a05
NC
8711@ifset XTENSA
8712@ifclear GENERIC
8713@raisesections
8714@end ifclear
8715
8716@node Xtensa
8717@section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
8718
8719@cindex Xtensa processors
8720The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
8721@code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
8722specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
8723keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
8724example, with the command:
8725
8726@smallexample
8727SECTIONS
8728@{
8729 .text : @{
8730 *(.literal .text)
8731 @}
8732@}
8733@end smallexample
8734
8735@noindent
8736@command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
8737and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
8738literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
8739interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
8740group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
8741files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
8742and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
e0001a05 8743
43cd72b9 8744@cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
e0001a05 8745@cindex relaxing on Xtensa
43cd72b9
BW
8746Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
8747provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
8748is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
8749literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
8750will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
8751location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
8752the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
8753unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
8754@code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
8755range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
8756
8757For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
8758to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
8759instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
8760instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
8761instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
8762@code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
8763hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
8764By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
8765switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
8766density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
8767instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
8768performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
8769linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
8770a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
8771
8772The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
8773control the linker:
8774
8775@cindex Xtensa options
8776@table @option
43cd72b9
BW
8777@item --size-opt
8778When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
8779more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
8780no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
8781alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
8782preserve the correctness of the code.
7a77f1ac
MF
8783
8784@item --abi-windowed
8785@itemx --abi-call0
8786Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
8787PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
8788because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
8789conventions.
8790Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
8791of the first input object.
8792A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
8793or the chosen output object ABI.
43cd72b9 8794@end table
e0001a05
NC
8795
8796@ifclear GENERIC
8797@lowersections
8798@end ifclear
8799@end ifset
8800
252b5132
RH
8801@ifclear SingleFormat
8802@node BFD
8803@chapter BFD
8804
8805@cindex back end
8806@cindex object file management
8807@cindex object formats available
8808@kindex objdump -i
8809The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
8810These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
8811object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
8812format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
8813it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
8814associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
8815object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
8816(@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
8817list all the formats available for your configuration.
8818
8819@cindex BFD requirements
8820@cindex requirements for BFD
8821As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
8822several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
8823BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
8824formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
8825been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
8826BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
8827may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
8828
8829One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
8830mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
8831useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
8832conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
8833
8834@menu
8835* BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
8836@end menu
8837
8838@node BFD outline
36f63dca 8839@section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
252b5132
RH
8840@cindex opening object files
8841@include bfdsumm.texi
8842@end ifclear
8843
8844@node Reporting Bugs
8845@chapter Reporting Bugs
ff5dcc92
SC
8846@cindex bugs in @command{ld}
8847@cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
252b5132 8848
ff5dcc92 8849Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
252b5132
RH
8850
8851Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
8852it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
ff5dcc92 8853to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
252b5132 8854work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
ff5dcc92 8855@command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
8856
8857In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
8858information that enables us to fix the bug.
8859
8860@menu
8861* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
8862* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
8863@end menu
8864
8865@node Bug Criteria
36f63dca 8866@section Have You Found a Bug?
252b5132
RH
8867@cindex bug criteria
8868
8869If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
8870
8871@itemize @bullet
8872@cindex fatal signal
8873@cindex linker crash
8874@cindex crash of linker
8875@item
8876If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
ff5dcc92 8877@command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
252b5132
RH
8878
8879@cindex error on valid input
8880@item
ff5dcc92 8881If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
252b5132
RH
8882
8883@cindex invalid input
8884@item
ff5dcc92 8885If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
252b5132
RH
8886may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
8887object files are correct.
8888
8889@item
8890If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
ff5dcc92 8891improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
252b5132
RH
8892@end itemize
8893
8894@node Bug Reporting
36f63dca 8895@section How to Report Bugs
252b5132 8896@cindex bug reports
ff5dcc92 8897@cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
252b5132
RH
8898
8899A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
ff5dcc92 8900products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
252b5132
RH
8901recommend you contact that organization first.
8902
8903You can find contact information for many support companies and
8904individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
8905distribution.
8906
ad22bfe8 8907@ifset BUGURL
ff5dcc92 8908Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
ad22bfe8
JM
8909@value{BUGURL}.
8910@end ifset
252b5132
RH
8911
8912The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
8913@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
8914fact or leave it out, state it!
8915
8916Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
8917problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
b553b183
NC
8918assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
8919matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
8920the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
8921location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
8922were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
8923into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
8924specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
c0065db7 8925and the most helpful.
b553b183
NC
8926
8927Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
8928the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
8929on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
252b5132
RH
8930
8931Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
36f63dca
NC
8932bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
8933respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
8934You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
252b5132
RH
8935
8936To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
8937
8938@itemize @bullet
8939@item
ff5dcc92 8940The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
252b5132
RH
8941the @samp{--version} argument.
8942
8943Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
ff5dcc92 8944the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
8945
8946@item
ff5dcc92 8947Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
252b5132
RH
8948patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
8949
8950@item
8951The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
8952version number.
8953
8954@item
ff5dcc92 8955What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
252b5132
RH
8956``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
8957
8958@item
8959The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
8960observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
8961list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
8962sufficient.
8963
8964If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
8965and then we might not encounter the bug.
8966
8967@item
8968A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
b553b183
NC
8969bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
8970provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
8971bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
8972state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
8973requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
8974we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
8975attachments are best.
252b5132
RH
8976
8977If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
8978@code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
8979object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
8980@code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
8981how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
8982
8983@item
8984A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
8985incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
8986
ff5dcc92 8987Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
252b5132
RH
8988will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
8989not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
8990a chance to make a mistake.
8991
8992Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
8993say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
b45619c0 8994copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
252b5132
RH
8995C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
8996and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
8997fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
8998you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
8999any conclusion from our observations.
9000
9001@item
ff5dcc92 9002If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
252b5132
RH
9003diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
9004@samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
ff5dcc92 9005If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
252b5132
RH
9006context, not by line number.
9007
9008The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
9009sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
9010@end itemize
9011
9012Here are some things that are not necessary:
9013
9014@itemize @bullet
9015@item
9016A description of the envelope of the bug.
9017
9018Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
9019which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
9020changes will not affect it.
9021
9022This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
9023will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
9024with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
9025We recommend that you save your time for something else.
9026
9027Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
9028of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
9029output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
9030less time, and so on.
9031
9032However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
9033report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
9034
9035@item
9036A patch for the bug.
9037
9038A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
9039the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
9040a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
9041to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
9042
ff5dcc92 9043Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
252b5132
RH
9044construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
9045through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
9046able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
9047fixed.
9048
9049And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
9050patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
9051help us to understand.
9052
9053@item
9054A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
9055
9056Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
9057things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
9058@end itemize
9059
9060@node MRI
9061@appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
9062@cindex MRI compatibility
ff5dcc92
SC
9063To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
9064linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
252b5132
RH
9065alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
9066described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
9067simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
ff5dcc92 9068@command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
252b5132
RH
9069linker commands; these commands are described here.
9070
9071In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
9072file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
9073features to make use of them.
9074
9075You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
9076@samp{-c} command-line option.
9077
9078Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
9079command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
9080blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
ff5dcc92 9081MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9082issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
9083
9084Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
9085
9086You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
9087lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
9088The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
9089
9090@table @code
9091@cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
9092@item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
9093@itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9094Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
252b5132
RH
9095the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9096@code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9097your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9098script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9099commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
9100input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9101@code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9102
9103@cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9104@item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9105Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9106in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9107
9108@var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9109
9110@cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9111@item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9112Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
9113@var{expression} should be a power of two.
9114
9115@cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9116@item BASE @var{expression}
9117Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9118absolute addresses) in the output file.
9119
9120@cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9121@item CHIP @var{expression}
9122@itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9123This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9124
9125@cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9126@item END
9127This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9128
9129@cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9130@item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9131Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
dc12032b 9132language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
252b5132
RH
9133
9134@cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9135@item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9136Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
ff5dcc92 9137@command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
252b5132
RH
9138
9139The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9140same line, with no change in its effect.
9141
9142@cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9143@item LOAD @var{filename}
9144@itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9145Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
ff5dcc92 9146same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9147command line.
9148
9149@cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9150@item NAME @var{output-name}
ff5dcc92 9151@var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
252b5132
RH
9152MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9153option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9154
9155@cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9156@item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9157@itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9158Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
252b5132
RH
9159order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9160script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9161sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9162file, in the order specified.
9163
9164@cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9165@item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9166@itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9167@itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9168Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9169@var{name} used in the linker input files.
9170
9171@cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9172@item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9173@itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9174@itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9175You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9176specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9177If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9178@var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9179@end table
9180
793c5807
NC
9181@node GNU Free Documentation License
9182@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
36f63dca 9183@include fdl.texi
704c465c 9184
370b66a1
CD
9185@node LD Index
9186@unnumbered LD Index
252b5132
RH
9187
9188@printindex cp
9189
9190@tex
7ca01ed9 9191% I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
252b5132
RH
9192% meantime:
9193\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9194\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9195\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9196\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9197\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9198\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9199\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9200\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9201\page\colophon
7ca01ed9 9202% Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
252b5132
RH
9203@end tex
9204
252b5132 9205@bye